postgresql/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c

12686 lines
394 KiB
C

/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
*
* xlog.c
* PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
*
*
* Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2020, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
* Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
*
* src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
*
*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
*/
#include "postgres.h"
#include <ctype.h>
#include <math.h>
#include <time.h>
#include <fcntl.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
#include <sys/time.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include "access/clog.h"
#include "access/commit_ts.h"
#include "access/heaptoast.h"
#include "access/multixact.h"
#include "access/rewriteheap.h"
#include "access/subtrans.h"
#include "access/timeline.h"
#include "access/transam.h"
#include "access/twophase.h"
#include "access/xact.h"
#include "access/xlog_internal.h"
#include "access/xlogarchive.h"
#include "access/xloginsert.h"
#include "access/xlogreader.h"
#include "access/xlogutils.h"
#include "catalog/catversion.h"
#include "catalog/pg_control.h"
#include "catalog/pg_database.h"
#include "commands/progress.h"
#include "commands/tablespace.h"
#include "common/controldata_utils.h"
#include "executor/instrument.h"
#include "miscadmin.h"
#include "pg_trace.h"
#include "pgstat.h"
#include "port/atomics.h"
#include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
#include "postmaster/startup.h"
#include "postmaster/walwriter.h"
#include "replication/basebackup.h"
#include "replication/logical.h"
#include "replication/origin.h"
#include "replication/slot.h"
#include "replication/snapbuild.h"
#include "replication/walreceiver.h"
#include "replication/walsender.h"
#include "storage/bufmgr.h"
#include "storage/fd.h"
#include "storage/ipc.h"
#include "storage/large_object.h"
#include "storage/latch.h"
#include "storage/pmsignal.h"
#include "storage/predicate.h"
#include "storage/proc.h"
#include "storage/procarray.h"
#include "storage/reinit.h"
#include "storage/smgr.h"
#include "storage/spin.h"
#include "storage/sync.h"
#include "utils/builtins.h"
#include "utils/guc.h"
#include "utils/memutils.h"
#include "utils/ps_status.h"
#include "utils/relmapper.h"
#include "utils/pg_rusage.h"
#include "utils/snapmgr.h"
#include "utils/timestamp.h"
extern uint32 bootstrap_data_checksum_version;
/* Unsupported old recovery command file names (relative to $PGDATA) */
#define RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE "recovery.conf"
#define RECOVERY_COMMAND_DONE "recovery.done"
/* User-settable parameters */
int max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
int min_wal_size_mb = 80; /* 80 MB */
int wal_keep_size_mb = 0;
int XLOGbuffers = -1;
int XLogArchiveTimeout = 0;
int XLogArchiveMode = ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF;
char *XLogArchiveCommand = NULL;
bool EnableHotStandby = false;
bool fullPageWrites = true;
bool wal_log_hints = false;
bool wal_compression = false;
char *wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL;
bool *wal_consistency_checking = NULL;
bool wal_init_zero = true;
bool wal_recycle = true;
bool log_checkpoints = false;
int sync_method = DEFAULT_SYNC_METHOD;
int wal_level = WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL;
int CommitDelay = 0; /* precommit delay in microseconds */
int CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
int wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000;
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1;
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
bool XLOG_DEBUG = false;
#endif
int wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE;
/*
* Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
* to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
* which needs to iterate all the locks.
*/
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS 8
/*
* Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
* checkpoint.
*/
int CheckPointSegments;
/* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0;
static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
/*
* GUC support
*/
const struct config_enum_entry sync_method_options[] = {
{"fsync", SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
{"fsync_writethrough", SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_FDATASYNC
{"fdatasync", SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
#endif
#ifdef OPEN_SYNC_FLAG
{"open_sync", SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
#endif
#ifdef OPEN_DATASYNC_FLAG
{"open_datasync", SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
#endif
{NULL, 0, false}
};
/*
* Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
* we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
*/
const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[] = {
{"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
{"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
{"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
{"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
{"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
{"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
{"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
{"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
{"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
{NULL, 0, false}
};
const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = {
{"pause", RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE, false},
{"promote", RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PROMOTE, false},
{"shutdown", RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_SHUTDOWN, false},
{NULL, 0, false}
};
/*
* Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
* Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
* checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
*/
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats;
/*
* ThisTimeLineID will be same in all backends --- it identifies current
* WAL timeline for the database system.
*/
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID = 0;
/*
* Are we doing recovery from XLOG?
*
* This is only ever true in the startup process; it should be read as meaning
* "this process is replaying WAL records", rather than "the system is in
* recovery mode". It should be examined primarily by functions that need
* to act differently when called from a WAL redo function (e.g., to skip WAL
* logging). To check whether the system is in recovery regardless of which
* process you're running in, use RecoveryInProgress() but only after shared
* memory startup and lock initialization.
*/
bool InRecovery = false;
/* Are we in Hot Standby mode? Only valid in startup process, see xlog.h */
HotStandbyState standbyState = STANDBY_DISABLED;
static XLogRecPtr LastRec;
/* Local copy of WalRcv->flushedUpto */
static XLogRecPtr flushedUpto = 0;
static TimeLineID receiveTLI = 0;
/*
* During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
* the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
* that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
* each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
*/
static bool lastFullPageWrites;
/*
* Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
* It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE. True actually
* means "not known, need to check the shared state".
*/
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
/*
* Local copy of SharedHotStandbyActive variable. False actually means "not
* known, need to check the shared state".
*/
static bool LocalHotStandbyActive = false;
/*
* Local copy of SharedPromoteIsTriggered variable. False actually means "not
* known, need to check the shared state".
*/
static bool LocalPromoteIsTriggered = false;
/*
* Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
* 1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
* 0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
* -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
* Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
* is not in progress. But we can also force the value for special cases.
* The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
* being numerically the same as bool true and false.
*/
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1;
/*
* When ArchiveRecoveryRequested is set, archive recovery was requested,
* ie. signal files were present. When InArchiveRecovery is set, we are
* currently recovering using offline XLOG archives. These variables are only
* valid in the startup process.
*
* When ArchiveRecoveryRequested is true, but InArchiveRecovery is false, we're
* currently performing crash recovery using only XLOG files in pg_wal, but
* will switch to using offline XLOG archives as soon as we reach the end of
* WAL in pg_wal.
*/
bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested = false;
bool InArchiveRecovery = false;
static bool standby_signal_file_found = false;
static bool recovery_signal_file_found = false;
/* Was the last xlog file restored from archive, or local? */
static bool restoredFromArchive = false;
/* Buffers dedicated to consistency checks of size BLCKSZ */
static char *replay_image_masked = NULL;
static char *primary_image_masked = NULL;
/* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */
char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL;
char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL;
char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL;
RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET;
bool recoveryTargetInclusive = true;
int recoveryTargetAction = RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE;
TransactionId recoveryTargetXid;
char *recovery_target_time_string;
static TimestampTz recoveryTargetTime;
const char *recoveryTargetName;
XLogRecPtr recoveryTargetLSN;
int recovery_min_apply_delay = 0;
/* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for XLOG streaming */
bool StandbyModeRequested = false;
char *PrimaryConnInfo = NULL;
char *PrimarySlotName = NULL;
char *PromoteTriggerFile = NULL;
bool wal_receiver_create_temp_slot = false;
/* are we currently in standby mode? */
bool StandbyMode = false;
/*
* if recoveryStopsBefore/After returns true, it saves information of the stop
* point here
*/
static TransactionId recoveryStopXid;
static TimestampTz recoveryStopTime;
static XLogRecPtr recoveryStopLSN;
static char recoveryStopName[MAXFNAMELEN];
static bool recoveryStopAfter;
/*
* During normal operation, the only timeline we care about is ThisTimeLineID.
* During recovery, however, things are more complicated. To simplify life
* for rmgr code, we keep ThisTimeLineID set to the "current" timeline as we
* scan through the WAL history (that is, it is the line that was active when
* the currently-scanned WAL record was generated). We also need these
* timeline values:
*
* recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal: what the user requested, if any
*
* recoveryTargetTLIRequested: numeric value of requested timeline, if constant
*
* recoveryTargetTLI: the currently understood target timeline; changes
*
* expectedTLEs: a list of TimeLineHistoryEntries for recoveryTargetTLI and the timelines of
* its known parents, newest first (so recoveryTargetTLI is always the
* first list member). Only these TLIs are expected to be seen in the WAL
* segments we read, and indeed only these TLIs will be considered as
* candidate WAL files to open at all.
*
* curFileTLI: the TLI appearing in the name of the current input WAL file.
* (This is not necessarily the same as ThisTimeLineID, because we could
* be scanning data that was copied from an ancestor timeline when the current
* file was created.) During a sequential scan we do not allow this value
* to decrease.
*/
RecoveryTargetTimeLineGoal recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal = RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST;
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLIRequested = 0;
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI = 0;
static List *expectedTLEs;
static TimeLineID curFileTLI;
/*
* ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
* current backend. It is updated for all inserts. XactLastRecEnd points to
* end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
* or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
* created any XLOG records.
*
* While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date. When committing,
* a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
* user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
* the transaction. But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
* parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
* stored here. The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
* in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
*/
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
/*
* RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
* (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
* CHECKPOINT record). We update this from the shared-memory copy,
* XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
* hold an insertion lock). See XLogInsertRecord for details. We are also
* allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
* see GetRedoRecPtr. A freshly spawned backend obtains the value during
* InitXLOGAccess.
*/
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr;
/*
* doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (forcePageWrites ||
* fullPageWrites). It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
* a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
*/
static bool doPageWrites;
/* Has the recovery code requested a walreceiver wakeup? */
static bool doRequestWalReceiverReply;
/*
* RedoStartLSN points to the checkpoint's REDO location which is specified
* in a backup label file, backup history file or control file. In standby
* mode, XLOG streaming usually starts from the position where an invalid
* record was found. But if we fail to read even the initial checkpoint
* record, we use the REDO location instead of the checkpoint location as
* the start position of XLOG streaming. Otherwise we would have to jump
* backwards to the REDO location after reading the checkpoint record,
* because the REDO record can precede the checkpoint record.
*/
static XLogRecPtr RedoStartLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
/*----------
* Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
*
* LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
* the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
* LogwrtResult indicates the byte positions we have already written/fsynced.
* These structs are identical but are declared separately to indicate their
* slightly different functions.
*
* To read XLogCtl->LogwrtResult, you must hold either info_lck or
* WALWriteLock. To update it, you need to hold both locks. The point of
* this arrangement is that the value can be examined by code that already
* holds WALWriteLock without needing to grab info_lck as well. In addition
* to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of LogwrtResult,
* which is updated when convenient.
*
* The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
* (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
*
* info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
* so it's a plain spinlock. The other locks are held longer (potentially
* over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them. These locks are:
*
* WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
* It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping. If the
* contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
* lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
*
* WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
* XLogFlush).
*
* ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
* new log file.
*
* CheckpointLock: must be held to do a checkpoint or restartpoint (ensures
* only one checkpointer at a time; currently, with all checkpoints done by
* the checkpointer, this is just pro forma).
*
*----------
*/
typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
{
XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 to write out */
XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 to flush */
} XLogwrtRqst;
typedef struct XLogwrtResult
{
XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 written out */
XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
} XLogwrtResult;
/*
* Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
* locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
* matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
* of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
* indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
*
* The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
* the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
* region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
* wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
* insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
* so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
* you're about to write out.
*
* This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
* inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
* buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
* to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
* inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
* insertion.
*
* Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
* the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
* to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
* updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
*
* lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
* using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
* important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
* was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
* updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
* set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
* records. Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
* advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
*/
typedef struct
{
LWLock lock;
XLogRecPtr insertingAt;
XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt;
} WALInsertLock;
/*
* All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
* force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
* indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
* cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
* array start address is suitably aligned.)
*/
typedef union WALInsertLockPadded
{
WALInsertLock l;
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
} WALInsertLockPadded;
/*
* State of an exclusive backup, necessary to control concurrent activities
* across sessions when working on exclusive backups.
*
* EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE means that there is no exclusive backup actually
* running, to be more precise pg_start_backup() is not being executed for
* an exclusive backup and there is no exclusive backup in progress.
* EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING means that pg_start_backup() is starting an
* exclusive backup.
* EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS means that pg_start_backup() has finished
* running and an exclusive backup is in progress. pg_stop_backup() is
* needed to finish it.
* EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING means that pg_stop_backup() is stopping an
* exclusive backup.
*/
typedef enum ExclusiveBackupState
{
EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE = 0,
EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING,
EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS,
EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING
} ExclusiveBackupState;
/*
* Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
* functions to start and stop backups.
*/
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
/*
* Shared state data for WAL insertion.
*/
typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
{
slock_t insertpos_lck; /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
/*
* CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
* inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
* previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
* prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
* positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
*/
uint64 CurrBytePos;
uint64 PrevBytePos;
/*
* Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
* on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
* write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
* read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
* those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
*/
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
/*
* fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
* determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
* instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
* full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
* actually affects WAL-logging by backends. Checkpointer sets at startup
* or after SIGHUP.
*
* To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
* you must hold ALL the locks.
*/
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* current redo point for insertions */
bool forcePageWrites; /* forcing full-page writes for PITR? */
bool fullPageWrites;
/*
* exclusiveBackupState indicates the state of an exclusive backup (see
* comments of ExclusiveBackupState for more details). nonExclusiveBackups
* is a counter indicating the number of streaming base backups currently
* in progress. forcePageWrites is set to true when either of these is
* non-zero. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location used
* as a starting point for an online backup.
*/
ExclusiveBackupState exclusiveBackupState;
int nonExclusiveBackups;
XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart;
/*
* WAL insertion locks.
*/
WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks;
} XLogCtlInsert;
/*
* Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
*/
typedef struct XLogCtlData
{
XLogCtlInsert Insert;
/* Protected by info_lck: */
XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst;
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
FullTransactionId ckptFullXid; /* nextXid of latest checkpoint */
XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN; /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN; /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
/* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. Protected by ulsn_lck. */
XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN;
slock_t ulsn_lck;
/* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime;
XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN;
/*
* Protected by info_lck and WALWriteLock (you must hold either lock to
* read it, but both to update)
*/
XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult;
/*
* Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
*
* To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
* hold WALBufMappingLock. To change the identity of a buffer that's
* still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
* you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
* in-progress insertions to the page by calling
* WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
*/
XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo;
/*
* These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
* and xlblocks values certainly do. xlblocks values are protected by
* WALBufMappingLock.
*/
char *pages; /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
XLogRecPtr *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
int XLogCacheBlck; /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
/*
* Shared copy of ThisTimeLineID. Does not change after end-of-recovery.
* If we created a new timeline when the system was started up,
* PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
* Otherwise it's equal to ThisTimeLineID.
*/
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID;
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID;
/*
* SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
* recovery. Protected by info_lck.
*/
RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState;
/*
* SharedHotStandbyActive indicates if we allow hot standby queries to be
* run. Protected by info_lck.
*/
bool SharedHotStandbyActive;
/*
* SharedPromoteIsTriggered indicates if a standby promotion has been
* triggered. Protected by info_lck.
*/
bool SharedPromoteIsTriggered;
/*
* WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
* low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
* Protected by info_lck.
*/
bool WalWriterSleeping;
/*
* recoveryWakeupLatch is used to wake up the startup process to continue
* WAL replay, if it is waiting for WAL to arrive or failover trigger file
* to appear.
*/
Latch recoveryWakeupLatch;
/*
* During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
* lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
* lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record. Used by the
* checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
*
* Protected by info_lck.
*/
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
/*
* lastReplayedEndRecPtr points to end+1 of the last record successfully
* replayed. When we're currently replaying a record, ie. in a redo
* function, replayEndRecPtr points to the end+1 of the record being
* replayed, otherwise it's equal to lastReplayedEndRecPtr.
*/
XLogRecPtr lastReplayedEndRecPtr;
TimeLineID lastReplayedTLI;
XLogRecPtr replayEndRecPtr;
TimeLineID replayEndTLI;
/* timestamp of last COMMIT/ABORT record replayed (or being replayed) */
TimestampTz recoveryLastXTime;
/*
* timestamp of when we started replaying the current chunk of WAL data,
* only relevant for replication or archive recovery
*/
TimestampTz currentChunkStartTime;
/* Are we requested to pause recovery? */
bool recoveryPause;
/*
* lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
* XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
*/
XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
slock_t info_lck; /* locks shared variables shown above */
} XLogCtlData;
static XLogCtlData *XLogCtl = NULL;
/* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
static WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks = NULL;
/*
* We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
*/
static ControlFileData *ControlFile = NULL;
/*
* Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
* multiple evaluation!
*/
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr) \
(((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
/* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
#define NextBufIdx(idx) \
(((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
/*
* XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
* would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
*/
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr) \
(((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
/*
* These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
*/
#define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
/*
* Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
* Rounds down.
*/
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize) XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
/* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
static int UsableBytesInSegment;
/*
* Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
* See discussion above.
*/
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult = {0, 0};
/*
* Codes indicating where we got a WAL file from during recovery, or where
* to attempt to get one.
*/
typedef enum
{
XLOG_FROM_ANY = 0, /* request to read WAL from any source */
XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE, /* restored using restore_command */
XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL, /* existing file in pg_wal */
XLOG_FROM_STREAM /* streamed from primary */
} XLogSource;
/* human-readable names for XLogSources, for debugging output */
static const char *const xlogSourceNames[] = {"any", "archive", "pg_wal", "stream"};
/*
* openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
* openLogSegNo identifies the segment. These variables are only used to
* write the XLOG, and so will normally refer to the active segment.
* Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
*/
static int openLogFile = -1;
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0;
/*
* These variables are used similarly to the ones above, but for reading
* the XLOG. Note, however, that readOff generally represents the offset
* of the page just read, not the seek position of the FD itself, which
* will be just past that page. readLen indicates how much of the current
* page has been read into readBuf, and readSource indicates where we got
* the currently open file from.
* Note: we could use Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of
* this FD too; but it doesn't currently seem worthwhile, since the XLOG is
* not read by general-purpose sessions.
*/
static int readFile = -1;
static XLogSegNo readSegNo = 0;
static uint32 readOff = 0;
static uint32 readLen = 0;
static XLogSource readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
/*
* Keeps track of which source we're currently reading from. This is
* different from readSource in that this is always set, even when we don't
* currently have a WAL file open. If lastSourceFailed is set, our last
* attempt to read from currentSource failed, and we should try another source
* next.
*
* pendingWalRcvRestart is set when a config change occurs that requires a
* walreceiver restart. This is only valid in XLOG_FROM_STREAM state.
*/
static XLogSource currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
static bool lastSourceFailed = false;
static bool pendingWalRcvRestart = false;
typedef struct XLogPageReadPrivate
{
int emode;
bool fetching_ckpt; /* are we fetching a checkpoint record? */
bool randAccess;
} XLogPageReadPrivate;
/*
* These variables track when we last obtained some WAL data to process,
* and where we got it from. (XLogReceiptSource is initially the same as
* readSource, but readSource gets reset to zero when we don't have data
* to process right now. It is also different from currentSource, which
* also changes when we try to read from a source and fail, while
* XLogReceiptSource tracks where we last successfully read some WAL.)
*/
static TimestampTz XLogReceiptTime = 0;
static XLogSource XLogReceiptSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
/* State information for XLOG reading */
static XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr; /* start of last record read */
static XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr; /* end+1 of last record read */
/*
* Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file. When running
* crash recovery, minRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
* expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
* switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
* Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
*/
static XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint;
static TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI;
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
/*
* Have we reached a consistent database state? In crash recovery, we have
* to replay all the WAL, so reachedConsistency is never set. During archive
* recovery, the database is consistent once minRecoveryPoint is reached.
*/
bool reachedConsistency = false;
static bool InRedo = false;
/* Have we launched bgwriter during recovery? */
static bool bgwriterLaunched = false;
/* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
static int MyLockNo = 0;
static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
static MemoryContext walDebugCxt = NULL;
#endif
static void readRecoverySignalFile(void);
static void validateRecoveryParameters(void);
static void exitArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog);
static bool recoveryStopsBefore(XLogReaderState *record);
static bool recoveryStopsAfter(XLogReaderState *record);
static void recoveryPausesHere(bool endOfRecovery);
static bool recoveryApplyDelay(XLogReaderState *record);
static void SetLatestXTime(TimestampTz xtime);
static void SetCurrentChunkStartTime(TimestampTz xtime);
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
static void XLogReportParameters(void);
static void checkTimeLineSwitch(XLogRecPtr lsn, TimeLineID newTLI,
TimeLineID prevTLI);
static void LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo);
static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void);
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, bool opportunistic);
static bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno);
static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, bool flexible);
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno,
bool use_lock);
static int XLogFileRead(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, TimeLineID tli,
XLogSource source, bool notfoundOk);
static int XLogFileReadAnyTLI(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, XLogSource source);
static int XLogPageRead(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, XLogRecPtr targetPagePtr,
int reqLen, XLogRecPtr targetRecPtr, char *readBuf);
static bool WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(XLogRecPtr RecPtr, bool randAccess,
bool fetching_ckpt, XLogRecPtr tliRecPtr);
static int emode_for_corrupt_record(int emode, XLogRecPtr RecPtr);
static void XLogFileClose(void);
static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr);
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr);
static void RemoveXlogFile(const char *segname, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr);
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
static XLogRecord *ReadRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader,
int emode, bool fetching_ckpt);
static void CheckRecoveryConsistency(void);
static XLogRecord *ReadCheckpointRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader,
XLogRecPtr RecPtr, int whichChkpt, bool report);
static bool rescanLatestTimeLine(void);
static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier);
static void WriteControlFile(void);
static void ReadControlFile(void);
static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow);
static void SetPromoteIsTriggered(void);
static bool CheckForStandbyTrigger(void);
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
static void xlog_outrec(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record);
#endif
static void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record);
static void pg_start_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg);
static void pg_stop_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg);
static bool read_backup_label(XLogRecPtr *checkPointLoc,
bool *backupEndRequired, bool *backupFromStandby);
static bool read_tablespace_map(List **tablespaces);
static void rm_redo_error_callback(void *arg);
static int get_sync_bit(int method);
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
XLogRecData *rdata,
XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos);
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto);
static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr);
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr);
static void checkXLogConsistency(XLogReaderState *record);
static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
/*
* Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
* chunks. This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
* and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
*
* If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
* WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
* images. If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
* insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr. The caller can then recalculate
* which pages need a full-page image, and retry. If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
* record is always inserted.
*
* 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
* XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
*
* The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
* data must be MAXALIGNed. XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
* xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
* by the caller.
*
* Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
* This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
* (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
* before the data page can be written out. This implements the basic
* WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
*/
XLogRecPtr
XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata,
XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn,
uint8 flags,
int num_fpi)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
pg_crc32c rdata_crc;
bool inserted;
XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
bool isLogSwitch = (rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID &&
info == XLOG_SWITCH);
XLogRecPtr StartPos;
XLogRecPtr EndPos;
bool prevDoPageWrites = doPageWrites;
/* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
Assert(rdata->len >= SizeOfXLogRecord);
/* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
/*----------
*
* We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
* lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
* record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
*
* 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
* reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
* insertpos_lck.
*
* 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
* correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
* record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
*
* To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
* inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
* an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
* has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
* determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
* boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
* inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
*
* Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
* fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
*
* Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
* page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
* initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
* to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
*
*----------
*/
START_CRIT_SECTION();
if (isLogSwitch)
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
else
WALInsertLockAcquire();
/*
* Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may have
* to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can only
* happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in this case
* and fast otherwise.
*
* Also check to see if fullPageWrites or forcePageWrites was just turned
* on; if we weren't already doing full-page writes then go back and
* recompute.
*
* If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't actually
* affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update our local copy
* but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was just turned off,
* we could recompute the record without full pages, but we choose not to
* bother.)
*/
if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
{
Assert(RedoRecPtr < Insert->RedoRecPtr);
RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
}
doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->forcePageWrites);
if (doPageWrites &&
(!prevDoPageWrites ||
(fpw_lsn != InvalidXLogRecPtr && fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr)))
{
/*
* Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller didn't
* back up. Start over.
*/
WALInsertLockRelease();
END_CRIT_SECTION();
return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
}
/*
* Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
* pointer.
*/
if (isLogSwitch)
inserted = ReserveXLogSwitch(&StartPos, &EndPos, &rechdr->xl_prev);
else
{
ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
&rechdr->xl_prev);
inserted = true;
}
if (inserted)
{
/*
* Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
* header.
*/
rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
COMP_CRC32C(rdata_crc, rechdr, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
FIN_CRC32C(rdata_crc);
rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
/*
* All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
* inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
*/
CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len, isLogSwitch, rdata,
StartPos, EndPos);
/*
* Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
* important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
* update the first one.
*/
if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
{
int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
WALInsertLocks[lockno].l.lastImportantAt = StartPos;
}
}
else
{
/*
* This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
* already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
* to do anything.
*/
}
/*
* Done! Let others know that we're finished.
*/
WALInsertLockRelease();
MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny();
END_CRIT_SECTION();
/*
* Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
*/
if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/* advance global request to include new block(s) */
if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < EndPos)
XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndPos;
/* update local result copy while I have the chance */
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
* padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
* end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
*/
if (isLogSwitch)
{
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_SWITCH();
XLogFlush(EndPos);
/*
* Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
* reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
* xlog-switch record.
*/
if (inserted)
{
EndPos = StartPos + SizeOfXLogRecord;
if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
{
uint64 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size);
if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
EndPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
else
EndPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
}
}
}
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
if (XLOG_DEBUG)
{
static XLogReaderState *debug_reader = NULL;
StringInfoData buf;
StringInfoData recordBuf;
char *errormsg = NULL;
MemoryContext oldCxt;
oldCxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(walDebugCxt);
initStringInfo(&buf);
appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%X: ",
(uint32) (EndPos >> 32), (uint32) EndPos);
/*
* We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
* entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
* contiguous chunk.
*/
initStringInfo(&recordBuf);
for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
appendBinaryStringInfo(&recordBuf, rdata->data, rdata->len);
if (!debug_reader)
debug_reader = XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL,
XL_ROUTINE(), NULL);
if (!debug_reader)
{
appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory");
}
else if (!DecodeXLogRecord(debug_reader, (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data,
&errormsg))
{
appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
}
else
{
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
xlog_outdesc(&buf, debug_reader);
}
elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
pfree(buf.data);
pfree(recordBuf.data);
MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldCxt);
}
#endif
/*
* Update our global variables
*/
ProcLastRecPtr = StartPos;
XactLastRecEnd = EndPos;
/* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
if (inserted)
{
pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
pgWalUsage.wal_records++;
pgWalUsage.wal_fpi += num_fpi;
}
return EndPos;
}
/*
* Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
* *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
* its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
* used to set the xl_prev of this record.
*
* This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
* across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
* section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
* busy system.
*
* NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
* where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
*/
static void
ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
uint64 startbytepos;
uint64 endbytepos;
uint64 prevbytepos;
size = MAXALIGN(size);
/* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
/*
* The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
* the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
* current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
* that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
* page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
* positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
* because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
* X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
*StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
*EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
*PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
/*
* Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
* XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
*/
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
}
/*
* Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
*
* A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
* segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
* *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
* segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
* reserving any space, and the function returns false.
*/
static bool
ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
uint64 startbytepos;
uint64 endbytepos;
uint64 prevbytepos;
uint32 size = MAXALIGN(SizeOfXLogRecord);
XLogRecPtr ptr;
uint32 segleft;
/*
* These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
* spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
* are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
* compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
ptr = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(startbytepos);
if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
{
SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
*EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
return false;
}
endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
*StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
*EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
segleft = wal_segment_size - XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size);
if (segleft != wal_segment_size)
{
/* consume the rest of the segment */
*EndPos += segleft;
endbytepos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos);
}
Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
*PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
return true;
}
/*
* Checks whether the current buffer page and backup page stored in the
* WAL record are consistent or not. Before comparing the two pages, a
* masking can be applied to the pages to ignore certain areas like hint bits,
* unused space between pd_lower and pd_upper among other things. This
* function should be called once WAL replay has been completed for a
* given record.
*/
static void
checkXLogConsistency(XLogReaderState *record)
{
RmgrId rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record);
RelFileNode rnode;
ForkNumber forknum;
BlockNumber blkno;
int block_id;
/* Records with no backup blocks have no need for consistency checks. */
if (!XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record))
return;
Assert((XLogRecGetInfo(record) & XLR_CHECK_CONSISTENCY) != 0);
for (block_id = 0; block_id <= record->max_block_id; block_id++)
{
Buffer buf;
Page page;
if (!XLogRecGetBlockTag(record, block_id, &rnode, &forknum, &blkno))
{
/*
* WAL record doesn't contain a block reference with the given id.
* Do nothing.
*/
continue;
}
Assert(XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id));
if (XLogRecBlockImageApply(record, block_id))
{
/*
* WAL record has already applied the page, so bypass the
* consistency check as that would result in comparing the full
* page stored in the record with itself.
*/
continue;
}
/*
* Read the contents from the current buffer and store it in a
* temporary page.
*/
buf = XLogReadBufferExtended(rnode, forknum, blkno,
RBM_NORMAL_NO_LOG);
if (!BufferIsValid(buf))
continue;
LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
page = BufferGetPage(buf);
/*
* Take a copy of the local page where WAL has been applied to have a
* comparison base before masking it...
*/
memcpy(replay_image_masked, page, BLCKSZ);
/* No need for this page anymore now that a copy is in. */
UnlockReleaseBuffer(buf);
/*
* If the block LSN is already ahead of this WAL record, we can't
* expect contents to match. This can happen if recovery is
* restarted.
*/
if (PageGetLSN(replay_image_masked) > record->EndRecPtr)
continue;
/*
* Read the contents from the backup copy, stored in WAL record and
* store it in a temporary page. There is no need to allocate a new
* page here, a local buffer is fine to hold its contents and a mask
* can be directly applied on it.
*/
if (!RestoreBlockImage(record, block_id, primary_image_masked))
elog(ERROR, "failed to restore block image");
/*
* If masking function is defined, mask both the primary and replay
* images
*/
if (RmgrTable[rmid].rm_mask != NULL)
{
RmgrTable[rmid].rm_mask(replay_image_masked, blkno);
RmgrTable[rmid].rm_mask(primary_image_masked, blkno);
}
/* Time to compare the primary and replay images. */
if (memcmp(replay_image_masked, primary_image_masked, BLCKSZ) != 0)
{
elog(FATAL,
"inconsistent page found, rel %u/%u/%u, forknum %u, blkno %u",
rnode.spcNode, rnode.dbNode, rnode.relNode,
forknum, blkno);
}
}
}
/*
* Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord. Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
* area in the WAL.
*/
static void
CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata,
XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos)
{
char *currpos;
int freespace;
int written;
XLogRecPtr CurrPos;
XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
/*
* Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
* inserting to.
*/
CurrPos = StartPos;
currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos);
freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
/*
* there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
* on this page.
*/
Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
/* Copy record data */
written = 0;
while (rdata != NULL)
{
char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
int rdata_len = rdata->len;
while (rdata_len > freespace)
{
/*
* Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
*/
Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
rdata_data += freespace;
rdata_len -= freespace;
written += freespace;
CurrPos += freespace;
/*
* Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
* in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
*
* It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
* lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
* page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
* only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
*/
currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos);
pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
/* skip over the page header */
if (XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
{
CurrPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
}
else
{
CurrPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
}
freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
}
Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
currpos += rdata_len;
CurrPos += rdata_len;
freespace -= rdata_len;
written += rdata_len;
rdata = rdata->next;
}
Assert(written == write_len);
/*
* If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
* we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We
* have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
*/
if (isLogSwitch && XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) != 0)
{
/* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
Assert(write_len == SizeOfXLogRecord);
/* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
/* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
CurrPos += freespace;
/*
* Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
* XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
* We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
* against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
*/
while (CurrPos < EndPos)
{
/*
* The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
* WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
* AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized
* mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
* variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
*
* The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
* headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
* differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with
* compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
* order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
*
* Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
* called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
* loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
* (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
* and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header.
*/
currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos);
MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
CurrPos += XLOG_BLCKSZ;
}
}
else
{
/* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
CurrPos = MAXALIGN64(CurrPos);
}
if (CurrPos != EndPos)
elog(PANIC, "space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written");
}
/*
* Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
*/
static void
WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
{
bool immed;
/*
* It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
* the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
* a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
* affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
* cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
*
* If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
* (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
* lot of very short connections.
*/
static int lockToTry = -1;
if (lockToTry == -1)
lockToTry = MyProc->pgprocno % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
MyLockNo = lockToTry;
/*
* The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
* insert location yet.
*/
immed = LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (!immed)
{
/*
* If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
* time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
* inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
* lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters
* than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
* across the locks.
*/
lockToTry = (lockToTry + 1) % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
}
}
/*
* Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
* to WAL.
*/
static void
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
{
int i;
/*
* When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
* indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
* XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
*/
for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
{
LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
&WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
PG_UINT64_MAX);
}
/* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
holdingAllLocks = true;
}
/*
* Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
*
* NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
* next time the lock is acquired.
*/
static void
WALInsertLockRelease(void)
{
if (holdingAllLocks)
{
int i;
for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
&WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
0);
holdingAllLocks = false;
}
else
{
LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
0);
}
}
/*
* Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
* inserting up to that point.
*/
static void
WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
{
if (holdingAllLocks)
{
/*
* We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
* WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
*/
LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.lock,
&WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.insertingAt,
insertingAt);
}
else
LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
insertingAt);
}
/*
* Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
*
* Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
* Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
* can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
* than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
*
* Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
* *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
* need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
* uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
* to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
*/
static XLogRecPtr
WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
{
uint64 bytepos;
XLogRecPtr reservedUpto;
XLogRecPtr finishedUpto;
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
int i;
if (MyProc == NULL)
elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
/* Read the current insert position */
SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
reservedUpto = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(bytepos);
/*
* No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
* reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
* LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
* complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
* that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
* corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
*/
if (upto > reservedUpto)
{
elog(LOG, "request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%X, currpos %X/%X",
(uint32) (upto >> 32), (uint32) upto,
(uint32) (reservedUpto >> 32), (uint32) reservedUpto);
upto = reservedUpto;
}
/*
* Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
* than 'upto'.
*
* finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
* the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
* reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
* out for any insertion that's still in progress.
*/
finishedUpto = reservedUpto;
for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
{
XLogRecPtr insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
do
{
/*
* See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will
* wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
* by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired,
* its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
* know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If
* it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
* same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
* calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will
* advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
* sleeping.
*/
if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
&WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
insertingat, &insertingat))
{
/* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
break;
}
/*
* This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
* inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
*/
} while (insertingat < upto);
if (insertingat != InvalidXLogRecPtr && insertingat < finishedUpto)
finishedUpto = insertingat;
}
return finishedUpto;
}
/*
* Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
* given XLogRecPtr.
*
* If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
* evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
*
* The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
* isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
* hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
* something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
* to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
* GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
* that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
* later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
*/
static char *
GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr)
{
int idx;
XLogRecPtr endptr;
static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
static char *cachedPos = NULL;
XLogRecPtr expectedEndPtr;
/*
* Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
* page as last time.
*/
if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
{
Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
}
/*
* The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
* particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
* page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
*/
idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
/*
* See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
* page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
* - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
* out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
* that doesn't happen.
*
* However, we don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone has
* just initialized the page, it's possible that we get a "torn read" of
* the XLogRecPtr if 64-bit fetches are not atomic on this platform. In
* that case we will see a bogus value. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping
* lock (in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything else than
* the page we're looking for. But it means that when we do this unlocked
* read, we might see a value that appears to be ahead of the page we're
* looking for. Don't PANIC on that, until we've verified the value while
* holding the lock.
*/
expectedEndPtr = ptr;
expectedEndPtr += XLOG_BLCKSZ - ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
endptr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx];
if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
{
XLogRecPtr initializedUpto;
/*
* Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
* know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
*
* NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
* position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
* there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
* up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
* the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
* though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
* inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
* sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
* the page header.
*/
if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) > XLOG_BLCKSZ)
initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) < XLOG_BLCKSZ)
initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
else
initializedUpto = ptr;
WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(initializedUpto);
AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, false);
endptr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx];
if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%X",
(uint32) (ptr >> 32), (uint32) ptr);
}
else
{
/*
* Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
* won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
*/
pg_memory_barrier();
}
/*
* Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
* offset within the page.
*/
cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
cachedPos = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
}
/*
* Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
* is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
* page headers.
*/
static XLogRecPtr
XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
{
uint64 fullsegs;
uint64 fullpages;
uint64 bytesleft;
uint32 seg_offset;
XLogRecPtr result;
fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
{
/* fits on first page of segment */
seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
}
else
{
/* account for the first page on segment with long header */
seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
}
XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
return result;
}
/*
* Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
* returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
* not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
* when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
*/
static XLogRecPtr
XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
{
uint64 fullsegs;
uint64 fullpages;
uint64 bytesleft;
uint32 seg_offset;
XLogRecPtr result;
fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
{
/* fits on first page of segment */
if (bytesleft == 0)
seg_offset = 0;
else
seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
}
else
{
/* account for the first page on segment with long header */
seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
if (bytesleft == 0)
seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft;
else
seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
}
XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
return result;
}
/*
* Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
*/
static uint64
XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
{
uint64 fullsegs;
uint32 fullpages;
uint32 offset;
uint64 result;
XLByteToSeg(ptr, fullsegs, wal_segment_size);
fullpages = (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size)) / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
if (fullpages == 0)
{
result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
if (offset > 0)
{
Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
}
}
else
{
result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
(XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
(fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */
if (offset > 0)
{
Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
}
}
return result;
}
/*
* Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
* unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
* true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
* unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
* initialized properly.
*/
static void
AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, bool opportunistic)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
int nextidx;
XLogRecPtr OldPageRqstPtr;
XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
XLogRecPtr NewPageEndPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
XLogRecPtr NewPageBeginPtr;
XLogPageHeader NewPage;
int npages = 0;
LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
/*
* Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
* already.
*/
while (upto >= XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo || opportunistic)
{
nextidx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo);
/*
* Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
* be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's
* already written out.
*/
OldPageRqstPtr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx];
if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
{
/*
* Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
* as we can without flushing, give up now.
*/
if (opportunistic)
break;
/* Before waiting, get info_lck and update LogwrtResult */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* Now that we have an up-to-date LogwrtResult value, see if we
* still need to write it or if someone else already did.
*/
if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
{
/*
* Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
* to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
* can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
* deadlock.
*/
LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(OldPageRqstPtr);
LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
if (LogwrtResult.Write >= OldPageRqstPtr)
{
/* OK, someone wrote it already */
LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
}
else
{
/* Have to write it ourselves */
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_START();
WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
XLogWrite(WriteRqst, false);
LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_DONE();
}
/* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
continue;
}
}
/*
* Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
* next output page.
*/
NewPageBeginPtr = XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo;
NewPageEndPtr = NewPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
Assert(XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(NewPageBeginPtr) == nextidx);
NewPage = (XLogPageHeader) (XLogCtl->pages + nextidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ);
/*
* Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
* written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
*/
MemSet((char *) NewPage, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
/*
* Fill the new page's header
*/
NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
/* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
NewPage->xlp_tli = ThisTimeLineID;
NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
/* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */
/*
* If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate
* that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup
* blocks. This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to
* compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into
* the non-full-block format. It is sufficient to record this at the
* page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment
* switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any
* records can be written during the backup. At the end of a backup,
* the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part
* is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to
* compress a few records.
*/
if (!Insert->forcePageWrites)
NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE;
/*
* If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
*/
if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
{
XLogLongPageHeader NewLongPage = (XLogLongPageHeader) NewPage;
NewLongPage->xlp_sysid = ControlFile->system_identifier;
NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
}
/*
* Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
* before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
* holding a lock.
*/
pg_write_barrier();
*((volatile XLogRecPtr *) &XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]) = NewPageEndPtr;
XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = NewPageEndPtr;
npages++;
}
LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
{
elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%X",
npages, (uint32) (NewPageEndPtr >> 32), (uint32) NewPageEndPtr);
}
#endif
}
/*
* Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
* checkpoint_completion_target.
*/
static void
CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
{
double target;
/*-------
* Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
* exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
*
* a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
* WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
* secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
* only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
* one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
* many smaller databases.)
* b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
* number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
*-------
*/
target = (double) ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) /
(1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget);
/* round down */
CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
CheckPointSegments = 1;
}
void
assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
{
max_wal_size_mb = newval;
CalculateCheckpointSegments();
}
void
assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
{
CheckPointCompletionTarget = newval;
CalculateCheckpointSegments();
}
/*
* At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
* XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
*/
static XLogSegNo
XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
{
XLogSegNo minSegNo;
XLogSegNo maxSegNo;
double distance;
XLogSegNo recycleSegNo;
/*
* Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
* correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
* remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
*/
minSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
maxSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
/*
* Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
* estimated end of next checkpoint.
*
* To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
* system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
* every checkpoint.
*/
distance = (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget) * CheckPointDistanceEstimate;
/* add 10% for good measure. */
distance *= 1.10;
recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
wal_segment_size);
if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
recycleSegNo = minSegNo;
if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
recycleSegNo = maxSegNo;
return recycleSegNo;
}
/*
* Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
*
* new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
* during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
* and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
*
* Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
*/
static bool
XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
{
XLogSegNo old_segno;
XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, old_segno, wal_segment_size);
if (new_segno >= old_segno + (uint64) (CheckPointSegments - 1))
return true;
return false;
}
/*
* Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
*
* If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
* may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
* This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
* single one would do.
*
* Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
* must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
* write.
*/
static void
XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, bool flexible)
{
bool ispartialpage;
bool last_iteration;
bool finishing_seg;
bool use_existent;
int curridx;
int npages;
int startidx;
uint32 startoffset;
/* We should always be inside a critical section here */
Assert(CritSectionCount > 0);
/*
* Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
*/
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
/*
* Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
* we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
* write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
* written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
* and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
* two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
* all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
*/
npages = 0;
startidx = 0;
startoffset = 0;
/*
* Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
* consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
* page, or last partially written page.
*/
curridx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(LogwrtResult.Write);
while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
{
/*
* Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen
* if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
* last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
*/
XLogRecPtr EndPtr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[curridx];
if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%X is past end of log %X/%X",
(uint32) (LogwrtResult.Write >> 32),
(uint32) LogwrtResult.Write,
(uint32) (EndPtr >> 32), (uint32) EndPtr);
/* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
LogwrtResult.Write = EndPtr;
ispartialpage = WriteRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write;
if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size))
{
/*
* Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending
* pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
*/
Assert(npages == 0);
if (openLogFile >= 0)
XLogFileClose();
XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size);
/* create/use new log file */
use_existent = true;
openLogFile = XLogFileInit(openLogSegNo, &use_existent, true);
ReserveExternalFD();
}
/* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
if (openLogFile < 0)
{
XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size);
openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo);
ReserveExternalFD();
}
/* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
if (npages == 0)
{
/* first of group */
startidx = curridx;
startoffset = XLogSegmentOffset(LogwrtResult.Write - XLOG_BLCKSZ,
wal_segment_size);
}
npages++;
/*
* Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
* at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
* contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
* segment.
*/
last_iteration = WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Write;
finishing_seg = !ispartialpage &&
(startoffset + npages * XLOG_BLCKSZ) >= wal_segment_size;
if (last_iteration ||
curridx == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck ||
finishing_seg)
{
char *from;
Size nbytes;
Size nleft;
int written;
/* OK to write the page(s) */
from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
nleft = nbytes;
do
{
errno = 0;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_WRITE);
written = pg_pwrite(openLogFile, from, nleft, startoffset);
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (written <= 0)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
int save_errno;
if (errno == EINTR)
continue;
save_errno = errno;
XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write to log file %s "
"at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
xlogfname, startoffset, nleft)));
}
nleft -= written;
from += written;
startoffset += written;
} while (nleft > 0);
npages = 0;
/*
* If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
* fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back
* and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
* later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
* perform this fsync.
*
* This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
* segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
* timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
* too many logfile segments have been used since the last
* checkpoint.
*/
if (finishing_seg)
{
issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo);
/* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
WalSndWakeupRequest();
LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */
if (XLogArchivingActive())
XLogArchiveNotifySeg(openLogSegNo);
XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = LogwrtResult.Flush;
/*
* Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
* the last one. For speed, we first check using the local
* copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
* like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
* recheck.
*/
if (IsUnderPostmaster && XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
{
(void) GetRedoRecPtr();
if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG);
}
}
}
if (ispartialpage)
{
/* Only asked to write a partial page */
LogwrtResult.Write = WriteRqst.Write;
break;
}
curridx = NextBufIdx(curridx);
/* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
if (flexible && npages == 0)
break;
}
Assert(npages == 0);
/*
* If asked to flush, do so
*/
if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
LogwrtResult.Flush < LogwrtResult.Write)
{
/*
* Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
* have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to
* fsync more than one file.
*/
if (sync_method != SYNC_METHOD_OPEN &&
sync_method != SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
{
if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size))
XLogFileClose();
if (openLogFile < 0)
{
XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size);
openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo);
ReserveExternalFD();
}
issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo);
}
/* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
WalSndWakeupRequest();
LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;
}
/*
* Update shared-memory status
*
* We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
* 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
* code in a couple of places.
*/
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->LogwrtResult = LogwrtResult;
if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write)
XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = LogwrtResult.Write;
if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush < LogwrtResult.Flush)
XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = LogwrtResult.Flush;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
}
/*
* Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
* and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
* (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
*/
void
XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
{
XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
bool sleeping;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
sleeping = XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping;
if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* If the WALWriter is sleeping, we should kick it to make it come out of
* low-power mode. Otherwise, determine whether there's a full page of
* WAL available to write.
*/
if (!sleeping)
{
/* back off to last completed page boundary */
WriteRqstPtr -= WriteRqstPtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
/* if we have already flushed that far, we're done */
if (WriteRqstPtr <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
return;
}
/*
* Nudge the WALWriter: it has a full page of WAL to write, or we want it
* to come out of low-power mode so that this async commit will reach disk
* within the expected amount of time.
*/
if (ProcGlobal->walwriterLatch)
SetLatch(ProcGlobal->walwriterLatch);
}
/*
* Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
* any replication slot.
*/
void
XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN = lsn;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
* replication slot.
*/
static XLogRecPtr
XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
{
XLogRecPtr retval;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
retval = XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return retval;
}
/*
* Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
*
* If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
* database is consistent.
*
* If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
* is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
*/
static void
UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
{
/* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= minRecoveryPoint))
return;
/*
* An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
* i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's
* value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
* local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
* updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup
* process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
* until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
* available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks
* taken on the control file from the startup process.
*/
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
{
updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
return;
}
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
/* update local copy */
minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint))
updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
else if (force || minRecoveryPoint < lsn)
{
XLogRecPtr newMinRecoveryPoint;
TimeLineID newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
/*
* To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
* all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
* would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case
* to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
*
* Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
* 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
* the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a
* value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
* all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
* (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
newMinRecoveryPoint = XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr;
newMinRecoveryPointTLI = XLogCtl->replayEndTLI;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
elog(WARNING,
"xlog min recovery request %X/%X is past current point %X/%X",
(uint32) (lsn >> 32), (uint32) lsn,
(uint32) (newMinRecoveryPoint >> 32),
(uint32) newMinRecoveryPoint);
/* update control file */
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < newMinRecoveryPoint)
{
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
UpdateControlFile();
minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
ereport(DEBUG2,
(errmsg("updated min recovery point to %X/%X on timeline %u",
(uint32) (minRecoveryPoint >> 32),
(uint32) minRecoveryPoint,
newMinRecoveryPointTLI)));
}
}
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
/*
* Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
*
* NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
* already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
*/
void
XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
{
XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr;
XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
/*
* During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of
* trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
* test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
* to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
* end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
*/
if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
{
UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
return;
}
/* Quick exit if already known flushed */
if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
return;
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
if (XLOG_DEBUG)
elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%X; write %X/%X; flush %X/%X",
(uint32) (record >> 32), (uint32) record,
(uint32) (LogwrtResult.Write >> 32), (uint32) LogwrtResult.Write,
(uint32) (LogwrtResult.Flush >> 32), (uint32) LogwrtResult.Flush);
#endif
START_CRIT_SECTION();
/*
* Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
* piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
* entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
* the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
* gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
*/
/* initialize to given target; may increase below */
WriteRqstPtr = record;
/*
* Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
* for us.
*/
for (;;)
{
XLogRecPtr insertpos;
/* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
WriteRqstPtr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/* done already? */
if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
break;
/*
* Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
* insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
*/
insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqstPtr);
/*
* Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
* until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
* or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
* helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
* is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
*/
if (!LWLockAcquireOrWait(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE))
{
/*
* The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
* do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
* us already.
*/
continue;
}
/* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
{
LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
break;
}
/*
* Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
* backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
* followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
* at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
*
* We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
* fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
*/
if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
MinimumActiveBackends(CommitSiblings))
{
pg_usleep(CommitDelay);
/*
* Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
* safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
* WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
* also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
* the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
* that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
* We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
* further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
*/
insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(insertpos);
}
/* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
XLogWrite(WriteRqst, false);
LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
/* done */
break;
}
END_CRIT_SECTION();
/* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
WalSndWakeupProcessRequests();
/*
* If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
* problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
* This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
*
* Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
* system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
* the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if
* the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
* unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually
* happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad
* LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
* the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
* end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
* bad LSN.
*
* Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
* since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However,
* calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
* force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
*/
if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
elog(ERROR,
"xlog flush request %X/%X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%X",
(uint32) (record >> 32), (uint32) record,
(uint32) (LogwrtResult.Flush >> 32), (uint32) LogwrtResult.Flush);
}
/*
* Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
*
* We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
* that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
* block, and write through the latest one of those. Thus, if async commits
* are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
*
* If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
* to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
* concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
* more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
*
* We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
* wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
* to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
* this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
* but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
*
* This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
*
* Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
* to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
*/
bool
XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
{
XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
bool flexible = true;
static TimestampTz lastflush;
TimestampTz now;
int flushbytes;
/* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
if (RecoveryInProgress())
return false;
/* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
WriteRqst = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/* back off to last completed page boundary */
WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
/* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
WriteRqst.Write = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */
}
/*
* If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
* holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
* preventing the file from being deleted.
*/
if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
{
if (openLogFile >= 0)
{
if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size))
{
XLogFileClose();
}
}
return false;
}
/*
* Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
* wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
*/
now = GetCurrentTimestamp();
flushbytes =
WriteRqst.Write / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
{
/* first call, or block based limits disabled */
WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
lastflush = now;
}
else if (TimestampDifferenceExceeds(lastflush, now, WalWriterDelay))
{
/*
* Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
* important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
* commit to hit disk.
*/
WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
lastflush = now;
}
else if (flushbytes >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
{
/* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
lastflush = now;
}
else
{
/* no flushing, this time round */
WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
}
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
if (XLOG_DEBUG)
elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%X; flush: %X/%X, current is write %X/%X; flush %X/%X",
(uint32) (WriteRqst.Write >> 32), (uint32) WriteRqst.Write,
(uint32) (WriteRqst.Flush >> 32), (uint32) WriteRqst.Flush,
(uint32) (LogwrtResult.Write >> 32), (uint32) LogwrtResult.Write,
(uint32) (LogwrtResult.Flush >> 32), (uint32) LogwrtResult.Flush);
#endif
START_CRIT_SECTION();
/* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst.Write);
LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
WriteRqst.Flush > LogwrtResult.Flush)
{
XLogWrite(WriteRqst, flexible);
}
LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
END_CRIT_SECTION();
/* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
WalSndWakeupProcessRequests();
/*
* Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
* as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
*/
AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
/*
* If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
* wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
* avoid hibernating too early.
*/
return true;
}
/*
* Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given position.
*
* Returns true if a flush is still needed. (It may be that someone else
* is already in process of flushing that far, however.)
*/
bool
XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
{
/*
* During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
* instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
* would need to be updated.
*/
if (RecoveryInProgress())
{
/*
* An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
* WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control
* file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
* here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
* which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
* it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
*/
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
/* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
if (record <= minRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint)
return false;
/*
* Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
* just return a conservative guess.
*/
if (!LWLockConditionalAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED))
return true;
minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/*
* Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
* process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
* file value if crash recovery is still running.
*/
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint))
updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
/* check again */
if (record <= minRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint)
return false;
else
return true;
}
/* Quick exit if already known flushed */
if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
return false;
/* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/* check again */
if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
return false;
return true;
}
/*
* Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
*
* logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
*
* *use_existent: if true, OK to use a pre-existing file (else, any
* pre-existing file will be deleted). On return, true if a pre-existing
* file was used.
*
* use_lock: if true, acquire ControlFileLock while moving file into
* place. This should be true except during bootstrap log creation. The
* caller must *not* hold the lock at call.
*
* Returns FD of opened file.
*
* Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
* inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
* take down the system on failure). They will promote to PANIC if we are
* in a critical section.
*/
int
XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, bool *use_existent, bool use_lock)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
PGAlignedXLogBlock zbuffer;
XLogSegNo installed_segno;
XLogSegNo max_segno;
int fd;
int nbytes;
int save_errno;
XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, logsegno, wal_segment_size);
/*
* Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
*/
if (*use_existent)
{
fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method));
if (fd < 0)
{
if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
}
else
return fd;
}
/*
* Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that
* another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up
* pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than
* holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
*/
elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
unlink(tmppath);
/* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
fd = BasicOpenFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
if (fd < 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
memset(zbuffer.data, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_WRITE);
save_errno = 0;
if (wal_init_zero)
{
/*
* Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to
* ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On
* platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
* doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we
* have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
* indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
* O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
*/
for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += XLOG_BLCKSZ)
{
errno = 0;
if (write(fd, zbuffer.data, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
{
/* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC;
break;
}
}
}
else
{
/*
* Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
* enough.
*/
errno = 0;
if (pg_pwrite(fd, zbuffer.data, 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
{
/* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC;
}
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (save_errno)
{
/*
* If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
*/
unlink(tmppath);
close(fd);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_SYNC);
if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
{
int save_errno = errno;
close(fd);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (close(fd) != 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
/*
* Now move the segment into place with its final name.
*
* If caller didn't want to use a pre-existing file, get rid of any
* pre-existing file. Otherwise, cope with possibility that someone else
* has created the file while we were filling ours: if so, use ours to
* pre-create a future log segment.
*/
installed_segno = logsegno;
/*
* XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
* that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
* checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
* here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
* normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
* the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
* CheckPointSegments.
*/
max_segno = logsegno + CheckPointSegments;
if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&installed_segno, tmppath,
*use_existent, max_segno,
use_lock))
{
/*
* No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
* failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, opening
* the file below will fail.
*/
unlink(tmppath);
}
/* Set flag to tell caller there was no existent file */
*use_existent = false;
/* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method));
if (fd < 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
return fd;
}
/*
* Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
*
* destsegno: identify segment to be created.
*
* srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
* a different timeline)
*
* upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
* zeros)
*
* Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
* considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
* emplacing a bogus file.
*/
static void
XLogFileCopy(XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno,
int upto)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
int srcfd;
int fd;
int nbytes;
/*
* Open the source file
*/
XLogFilePath(path, srcTLI, srcsegno, wal_segment_size);
srcfd = OpenTransientFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY);
if (srcfd < 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
/*
* Copy into a temp file name.
*/
snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
unlink(tmppath);
/* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
fd = OpenTransientFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
if (fd < 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
/*
* Do the data copying.
*/
for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
{
int nread;
nread = upto - nbytes;
/*
* The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
* zeros.
*/
if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
if (nread > 0)
{
int r;
if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
nread = sizeof(buffer);
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_READ);
r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
if (r != nread)
{
if (r < 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
path)));
else
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
path, r, (Size) nread)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
}
errno = 0;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_WRITE);
if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
{
int save_errno = errno;
/*
* If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
*/
unlink(tmppath);
/* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
errno = save_errno ? save_errno : ENOSPC;
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
}
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_SYNC);
if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
ereport(data_sync_elevel(ERROR),
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
/*
* Now move the segment into place with its final name.
*/
if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&destsegno, tmppath, false, 0, false))
elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
}
/*
* Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
*
* This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
* filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
*
* *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
* When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
* actual installation location or last segment searched.
*
* tmppath: initial name of file to install. It will be renamed into place.
*
* find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
* number at or after the passed numbers. If false, install the new segment
* exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
*
* max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as. Fail if no
* free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
* is false.)
*
* use_lock: if true, acquire ControlFileLock while moving file into
* place. This should be true except during bootstrap log creation. The
* caller must *not* hold the lock at call.
*
* Returns true if the file was installed successfully. false indicates that
* max_segno limit was exceeded, or an error occurred while renaming the
* file into place.
*/
static bool
InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno,
bool use_lock)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
struct stat stat_buf;
XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, *segno, wal_segment_size);
/*
* We want to be sure that only one process does this at a time.
*/
if (use_lock)
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (!find_free)
{
/* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
}
else
{
/* Find a free slot to put it in */
while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
{
if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
{
/* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
if (use_lock)
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
return false;
}
(*segno)++;
XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, *segno, wal_segment_size);
}
}
/*
* Perform the rename using link if available, paranoidly trying to avoid
* overwriting an existing file (there shouldn't be one).
*/
if (durable_rename_excl(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
{
if (use_lock)
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/* durable_rename_excl already emitted log message */
return false;
}
if (use_lock)
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
return true;
}
/*
* Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
*/
int
XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
int fd;
XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, segno, wal_segment_size);
fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method));
if (fd < 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
return fd;
}
/*
* Open a logfile segment for reading (during recovery).
*
* If source == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE, the segment is retrieved from archive.
* Otherwise, it's assumed to be already available in pg_wal.
*/
static int
XLogFileRead(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, TimeLineID tli,
XLogSource source, bool notfoundOk)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
char activitymsg[MAXFNAMELEN + 16];
char path[MAXPGPATH];
int fd;
XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
switch (source)
{
case XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE:
/* Report recovery progress in PS display */
snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "waiting for %s",
xlogfname);
set_ps_display(activitymsg);
restoredFromArchive = RestoreArchivedFile(path, xlogfname,
"RECOVERYXLOG",
wal_segment_size,
InRedo);
if (!restoredFromArchive)
return -1;
break;
case XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL:
case XLOG_FROM_STREAM:
XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
restoredFromArchive = false;
break;
default:
elog(ERROR, "invalid XLogFileRead source %d", source);
}
/*
* If the segment was fetched from archival storage, replace the existing
* xlog segment (if any) with the archival version.
*/
if (source == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE)
{
KeepFileRestoredFromArchive(path, xlogfname);
/*
* Set path to point at the new file in pg_wal.
*/
snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlogfname);
}
fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY);
if (fd >= 0)
{
/* Success! */
curFileTLI = tli;
/* Report recovery progress in PS display */
snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "recovering %s",
xlogfname);
set_ps_display(activitymsg);
/* Track source of data in assorted state variables */
readSource = source;
XLogReceiptSource = source;
/* In FROM_STREAM case, caller tracks receipt time, not me */
if (source != XLOG_FROM_STREAM)
XLogReceiptTime = GetCurrentTimestamp();
return fd;
}
if (errno != ENOENT || !notfoundOk) /* unexpected failure? */
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
return -1;
}
/*
* Open a logfile segment for reading (during recovery).
*
* This version searches for the segment with any TLI listed in expectedTLEs.
*/
static int
XLogFileReadAnyTLI(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, XLogSource source)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
ListCell *cell;
int fd;
List *tles;
/*
* Loop looking for a suitable timeline ID: we might need to read any of
* the timelines listed in expectedTLEs.
*
* We expect curFileTLI on entry to be the TLI of the preceding file in
* sequence, or 0 if there was no predecessor. We do not allow curFileTLI
* to go backwards; this prevents us from picking up the wrong file when a
* parent timeline extends to higher segment numbers than the child we
* want to read.
*
* If we haven't read the timeline history file yet, read it now, so that
* we know which TLIs to scan. We don't save the list in expectedTLEs,
* however, unless we actually find a valid segment. That way if there is
* neither a timeline history file nor a WAL segment in the archive, and
* streaming replication is set up, we'll read the timeline history file
* streamed from the primary when we start streaming, instead of recovering
* with a dummy history generated here.
*/
if (expectedTLEs)
tles = expectedTLEs;
else
tles = readTimeLineHistory(recoveryTargetTLI);
foreach(cell, tles)
{
TimeLineHistoryEntry *hent = (TimeLineHistoryEntry *) lfirst(cell);
TimeLineID tli = hent->tli;
if (tli < curFileTLI)
break; /* don't bother looking at too-old TLIs */
/*
* Skip scanning the timeline ID that the logfile segment to read
* doesn't belong to
*/
if (hent->begin != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
{
XLogSegNo beginseg = 0;
XLByteToSeg(hent->begin, beginseg, wal_segment_size);
/*
* The logfile segment that doesn't belong to the timeline is
* older or newer than the segment that the timeline started or
* ended at, respectively. It's sufficient to check only the
* starting segment of the timeline here. Since the timelines are
* scanned in descending order in this loop, any segments newer
* than the ending segment should belong to newer timeline and
* have already been read before. So it's not necessary to check
* the ending segment of the timeline here.
*/
if (segno < beginseg)
continue;
}
if (source == XLOG_FROM_ANY || source == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE)
{
fd = XLogFileRead(segno, emode, tli,
XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE, true);
if (fd != -1)
{
elog(DEBUG1, "got WAL segment from archive");
if (!expectedTLEs)
expectedTLEs = tles;
return fd;
}
}
if (source == XLOG_FROM_ANY || source == XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL)
{
fd = XLogFileRead(segno, emode, tli,
XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL, true);
if (fd != -1)
{
if (!expectedTLEs)
expectedTLEs = tles;
return fd;
}
}
}
/* Couldn't find it. For simplicity, complain about front timeline */
XLogFilePath(path, recoveryTargetTLI, segno, wal_segment_size);
errno = ENOENT;
ereport(emode,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
return -1;
}
/*
* Close the current logfile segment for writing.
*/
static void
XLogFileClose(void)
{
Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
/*
* WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
* the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving
* or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
* use the cache to read the WAL segment.
*/
#if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
if (!XLogIsNeeded())
(void) posix_fadvise(openLogFile, 0, 0, POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED);
#endif
if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
int save_errno = errno;
XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, openLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
}
openLogFile = -1;
ReleaseExternalFD();
}
/*
* Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
*
* XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
* future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
* the current one. This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
* High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
* recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
* a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
*/
static void
PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr)
{
XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
int lf;
bool use_existent;
uint64 offset;
XLByteToPrevSeg(endptr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
{
_logSegNo++;
use_existent = true;
lf = XLogFileInit(_logSegNo, &use_existent, true);
close(lf);
if (!use_existent)
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added++;
}
}
/*
* Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
* recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
* existed while the server has been running, as this function always
* succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
* 'tli' is only used in the error message.
*
* Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
* This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
* error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
* a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
*/
void
CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
{
int save_errno = errno;
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
{
char filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
XLogFileName(filename, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
filename)));
}
errno = save_errno;
}
/*
* Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
* since startup.
*
* NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
* with that.
*/
XLogSegNo
XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
{
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return lastRemovedSegNo;
}
/*
* Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
* given XLOG file has been removed.
*/
static void
UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
{
uint32 tli;
XLogSegNo segno;
XLogFromFileName(filename, &tli, &segno, wal_segment_size);
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
*
* This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
* at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
*/
static void
RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
{
DIR *xldir;
struct dirent *xlde;
elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
continue;
snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
unlink(path);
elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
}
FreeDir(xldir);
}
/*
* Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
*
* endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
* redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
* whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
*/
static void
RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr)
{
DIR *xldir;
struct dirent *xlde;
char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
/*
* Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
* doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
* ThisTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
*/
XLogFileName(lastoff, 0, segno, wal_segment_size);
elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
lastoff);
xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
{
/* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
!IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
continue;
/*
* We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
* deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we
* won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
* probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
* non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
* complicated.
*
* We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
* which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
*/
if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
{
if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
{
/* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
RemoveXlogFile(xlde->d_name, lastredoptr, endptr);
}
}
}
FreeDir(xldir);
}
/*
* Remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's history.
*
* This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
* timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
* wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
* might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
* that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
* pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
* Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
* successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
*
* 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
* and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
*/
static void
RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
{
DIR *xldir;
struct dirent *xlde;
char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
XLogSegNo endLogSegNo;
XLByteToPrevSeg(switchpoint, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
/*
* Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
*/
XLogFileName(switchseg, newTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
switchseg);
xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
{
/* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
continue;
/*
* Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
* switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
* new timeline.
*/
if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
{
/*
* If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
* remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
* not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
* - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
*/
if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
RemoveXlogFile(xlde->d_name, InvalidXLogRecPtr, switchpoint);
}
}
FreeDir(xldir);
}
/*
* Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
*
* endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
* redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
* whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
* If lastredoptr is not known, pass invalid, and the function will recycle,
* somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
*/
static void
RemoveXlogFile(const char *segname, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
#ifdef WIN32
char newpath[MAXPGPATH];
#endif
struct stat statbuf;
XLogSegNo endlogSegNo;
XLogSegNo recycleSegNo;
if (wal_recycle)
{
/*
* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to.
*/
XLByteToSeg(endptr, endlogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
if (lastredoptr == InvalidXLogRecPtr)
recycleSegNo = endlogSegNo + 10;
else
recycleSegNo = XLOGfileslop(lastredoptr);
}
else
recycleSegNo = 0; /* keep compiler quiet */
snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
/*
* Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
* segment. Only recycle normal files, pg_standby for example can create
* symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
*/
if (wal_recycle &&
endlogSegNo <= recycleSegNo &&
lstat(path, &statbuf) == 0 && S_ISREG(statbuf.st_mode) &&
InstallXLogFileSegment(&endlogSegNo, path,
true, recycleSegNo, true))
{
ereport(DEBUG2,
(errmsg("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
segname)));
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled++;
/* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
endlogSegNo++;
}
else
{
/* No need for any more future segments... */
int rc;
ereport(DEBUG2,
(errmsg("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
segname)));
#ifdef WIN32
/*
* On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
* open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
* will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
* closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
* WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
*
* If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
* flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
*/
snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
path)));
return;
}
rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
#else
rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
#endif
if (rc != 0)
{
/* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
return;
}
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed++;
}
XLogArchiveCleanup(segname);
}
/*
* Verify whether pg_wal and pg_wal/archive_status exist.
* If the latter does not exist, recreate it.
*
* It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
* directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
* copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
*
* We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
* policy decision was made not to. It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
* a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
* plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
*/
static void
ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
{
char path[MAXPGPATH];
struct stat stat_buf;
/* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
XLOGDIR)));
/* Check for archive_status */
snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
{
/* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
path)));
}
else
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
path)));
}
}
/*
* Remove previous backup history files. This also retries creation of
* .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
* failed earlier.
*/
static void
CleanupBackupHistory(void)
{
DIR *xldir;
struct dirent *xlde;
char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
{
if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
{
if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
{
elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
xlde->d_name);
snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
unlink(path);
XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
}
}
}
FreeDir(xldir);
}
/*
* Attempt to read the next XLOG record.
*
* Before first call, the reader needs to be positioned to the first record
* by calling XLogBeginRead().
*
* If no valid record is available, returns NULL, or fails if emode is PANIC.
* (emode must be either PANIC, LOG). In standby mode, retries until a valid
* record is available.
*/
static XLogRecord *
ReadRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, int emode,
bool fetching_ckpt)
{
XLogRecord *record;
XLogPageReadPrivate *private = (XLogPageReadPrivate *) xlogreader->private_data;
/* Pass through parameters to XLogPageRead */
private->fetching_ckpt = fetching_ckpt;
private->emode = emode;
private->randAccess = (xlogreader->ReadRecPtr == InvalidXLogRecPtr);
/* This is the first attempt to read this page. */
lastSourceFailed = false;
for (;;)
{
char *errormsg;
record = XLogReadRecord(xlogreader, &errormsg);
ReadRecPtr = xlogreader->ReadRecPtr;
EndRecPtr = xlogreader->EndRecPtr;
if (record == NULL)
{
if (readFile >= 0)
{
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
}
/*
* We only end up here without a message when XLogPageRead()
* failed - in that case we already logged something. In
* StandbyMode that only happens if we have been triggered, so we
* shouldn't loop anymore in that case.
*/
if (errormsg)
ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, EndRecPtr),
(errmsg_internal("%s", errormsg) /* already translated */ ));
}
/*
* Check page TLI is one of the expected values.
*/
else if (!tliInHistory(xlogreader->latestPageTLI, expectedTLEs))
{
char fname[MAXFNAMELEN];
XLogSegNo segno;
int32 offset;
XLByteToSeg(xlogreader->latestPagePtr, segno, wal_segment_size);
offset = XLogSegmentOffset(xlogreader->latestPagePtr,
wal_segment_size);
XLogFileName(fname, xlogreader->seg.ws_tli, segno,
wal_segment_size);
ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, EndRecPtr),
(errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u in log segment %s, offset %u",
xlogreader->latestPageTLI,
fname,
offset)));
record = NULL;
}
if (record)
{
/* Great, got a record */
return record;
}
else
{
/* No valid record available from this source */
lastSourceFailed = true;
/*
* If archive recovery was requested, but we were still doing
* crash recovery, switch to archive recovery and retry using the
* offline archive. We have now replayed all the valid WAL in
* pg_wal, so we are presumably now consistent.
*
* We require that there's at least some valid WAL present in
* pg_wal, however (!fetching_ckpt). We could recover using the
* WAL from the archive, even if pg_wal is completely empty, but
* we'd have no idea how far we'd have to replay to reach
* consistency. So err on the safe side and give up.
*/
if (!InArchiveRecovery && ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
!fetching_ckpt)
{
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("reached end of WAL in pg_wal, entering archive recovery")));
InArchiveRecovery = true;
if (StandbyModeRequested)
StandbyMode = true;
/* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY;
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
{
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
}
/* update local copy */
minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
/*
* The startup process can update its local copy of
* minRecoveryPoint from this point.
*/
updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
UpdateControlFile();
/*
* We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on
* ControlFileLock so both states are consistent in shared
* memory.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
CheckRecoveryConsistency();
/*
* Before we retry, reset lastSourceFailed and currentSource
* so that we will check the archive next.
*/
lastSourceFailed = false;
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
continue;
}
/* In standby mode, loop back to retry. Otherwise, give up. */
if (StandbyMode && !CheckForStandbyTrigger())
continue;
else
return NULL;
}
}
}
/*
* Scan for new timelines that might have appeared in the archive since we
* started recovery.
*
* If there are any, the function changes recovery target TLI to the latest
* one and returns 'true'.
*/
static bool
rescanLatestTimeLine(void)
{
List *newExpectedTLEs;
bool found;
ListCell *cell;
TimeLineID newtarget;
TimeLineID oldtarget = recoveryTargetTLI;
TimeLineHistoryEntry *currentTle = NULL;
newtarget = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI);
if (newtarget == recoveryTargetTLI)
{
/* No new timelines found */
return false;
}
/*
* Determine the list of expected TLIs for the new TLI
*/
newExpectedTLEs = readTimeLineHistory(newtarget);
/*
* If the current timeline is not part of the history of the new timeline,
* we cannot proceed to it.
*/
found = false;
foreach(cell, newExpectedTLEs)
{
currentTle = (TimeLineHistoryEntry *) lfirst(cell);
if (currentTle->tli == recoveryTargetTLI)
{
found = true;
break;
}
}
if (!found)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("new timeline %u is not a child of database system timeline %u",
newtarget,
ThisTimeLineID)));
return false;
}
/*
* The current timeline was found in the history file, but check that the
* next timeline was forked off from it *after* the current recovery
* location.
*/
if (currentTle->end < EndRecPtr)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("new timeline %u forked off current database system timeline %u before current recovery point %X/%X",
newtarget,
ThisTimeLineID,
(uint32) (EndRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) EndRecPtr)));
return false;
}
/* The new timeline history seems valid. Switch target */
recoveryTargetTLI = newtarget;
list_free_deep(expectedTLEs);
expectedTLEs = newExpectedTLEs;
/*
* As in StartupXLOG(), try to ensure we have all the history files
* between the old target and new target in pg_wal.
*/
restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(oldtarget + 1, newtarget);
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("new target timeline is %u",
recoveryTargetTLI)));
return true;
}
/*
* I/O routines for pg_control
*
* *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
* contents of pg_control. WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
* given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
* the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
* and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
* InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
*
* For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
* that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
* ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct. We could split out the
* I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
*/
static void
InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier)
{
char mock_auth_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN];
/*
* Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
* will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
* a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
* of an actual stored password.
*/
if (!pg_strong_random(mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN))
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode(ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR),
errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
/* Initialize pg_control status fields */
ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
memcpy(ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce, mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN);
ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
ControlFile->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN;
/* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
ControlFile->data_checksum_version = bootstrap_data_checksum_version;
}
static void
WriteControlFile(void)
{
int fd;
char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */
/*
* Ensure that the size of the pg_control data structure is sane. See the
* comments for these symbols in pg_control.h.
*/
StaticAssertStmt(sizeof(ControlFileData) <= PG_CONTROL_MAX_SAFE_SIZE,
"pg_control is too large for atomic disk writes");
StaticAssertStmt(sizeof(ControlFileData) <= PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE,
"sizeof(ControlFileData) exceeds PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE");
/*
* Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
*/
ControlFile->pg_control_version = PG_CONTROL_VERSION;
ControlFile->catalog_version_no = CATALOG_VERSION_NO;
ControlFile->maxAlign = MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF;
ControlFile->floatFormat = FLOATFORMAT_VALUE;
ControlFile->blcksz = BLCKSZ;
ControlFile->relseg_size = RELSEG_SIZE;
ControlFile->xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
ControlFile->xlog_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
ControlFile->nameDataLen = NAMEDATALEN;
ControlFile->indexMaxKeys = INDEX_MAX_KEYS;
ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size = TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE;
ControlFile->loblksize = LOBLKSIZE;
ControlFile->float8ByVal = FLOAT8PASSBYVAL;
/* Contents are protected with a CRC */
INIT_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
COMP_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc,
(char *) ControlFile,
offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
FIN_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
/*
* We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
* the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of
* premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we
* check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
* error than "couldn't read pg_control".
*/
memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
if (fd < 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
errno = 0;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_WRITE);
if (write(fd, buffer, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE) != PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE)
{
/* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
if (errno == 0)
errno = ENOSPC;
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_SYNC);
if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (close(fd) != 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
}
static void
ReadControlFile(void)
{
pg_crc32c crc;
int fd;
static char wal_segsz_str[20];
int r;
/*
* Read data...
*/
fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
if (fd < 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_READ);
r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
{
if (r < 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
else
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
close(fd);
/*
* Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the
* CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
* of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
* enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
*/
if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION && ControlFile->pg_control_version % 65536 == 0 && ControlFile->pg_control_version / 65536 != 0)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
" but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
ControlFile->pg_control_version, ControlFile->pg_control_version,
PG_CONTROL_VERSION, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
" but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
ControlFile->pg_control_version, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
/* Now check the CRC. */
INIT_CRC32C(crc);
COMP_CRC32C(crc,
(char *) ControlFile,
offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
FIN_CRC32C(crc);
if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
/*
* Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't
* compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
* possibly do any damage.
*/
if (ControlFile->catalog_version_no != CATALOG_VERSION_NO)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with CATALOG_VERSION_NO %d,"
" but the server was compiled with CATALOG_VERSION_NO %d.",
ControlFile->catalog_version_no, CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->maxAlign != MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with MAXALIGN %d,"
" but the server was compiled with MAXALIGN %d.",
ControlFile->maxAlign, MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->floatFormat != FLOATFORMAT_VALUE)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with BLCKSZ %d,"
" but the server was compiled with BLCKSZ %d.",
ControlFile->blcksz, BLCKSZ),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->relseg_size != RELSEG_SIZE)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with RELSEG_SIZE %d,"
" but the server was compiled with RELSEG_SIZE %d.",
ControlFile->relseg_size, RELSEG_SIZE),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->xlog_blcksz != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with XLOG_BLCKSZ %d,"
" but the server was compiled with XLOG_BLCKSZ %d.",
ControlFile->xlog_blcksz, XLOG_BLCKSZ),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->nameDataLen != NAMEDATALEN)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with NAMEDATALEN %d,"
" but the server was compiled with NAMEDATALEN %d.",
ControlFile->nameDataLen, NAMEDATALEN),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->indexMaxKeys != INDEX_MAX_KEYS)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with INDEX_MAX_KEYS %d,"
" but the server was compiled with INDEX_MAX_KEYS %d.",
ControlFile->indexMaxKeys, INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size != TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE %d,"
" but the server was compiled with TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE %d.",
ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size, (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
if (ControlFile->loblksize != LOBLKSIZE)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with LOBLKSIZE %d,"
" but the server was compiled with LOBLKSIZE %d.",
ControlFile->loblksize, (int) LOBLKSIZE),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
#ifdef USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL
if (ControlFile->float8ByVal != true)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized without USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL"
" but the server was compiled with USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL."),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
#else
if (ControlFile->float8ByVal != false)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL"
" but the server was compiled without USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL."),
errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
#endif
wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size;
if (!IsValidWalSegSize(wal_segment_size))
ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
errmsg_plural("WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB, but the control file specifies %d byte",
"WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB, but the control file specifies %d bytes",
wal_segment_size,
wal_segment_size)));
snprintf(wal_segsz_str, sizeof(wal_segsz_str), "%d", wal_segment_size);
SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
PGC_S_OVERRIDE);
/* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
if (ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
errmsg("\"min_wal_size\" must be at least twice \"wal_segment_size\"")));
if (ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
errmsg("\"max_wal_size\" must be at least twice \"wal_segment_size\"")));
UsableBytesInSegment =
(wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ * UsableBytesInPage) -
(SizeOfXLogLongPHD - SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
CalculateCheckpointSegments();
/* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_OVERRIDE);
}
/*
* Utility wrapper to update the control file. Note that the control
* file gets flushed.
*/
void
UpdateControlFile(void)
{
update_controlfile(DataDir, ControlFile, true);
}
/*
* Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
*/
uint64
GetSystemIdentifier(void)
{
Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
return ControlFile->system_identifier;
}
/*
* Returns the random nonce from control file.
*/
char *
GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
{
Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
return ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce;
}
/*
* Are checksums enabled for data pages?
*/
bool
DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
{
Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
}
/*
* Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
*
* Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
* returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
* shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
* be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
* LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
{
XLogRecPtr nextUnloggedLSN;
/* increment the unloggedLSN counter, need SpinLock */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck);
nextUnloggedLSN = XLogCtl->unloggedLSN++;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck);
return nextUnloggedLSN;
}
/*
* Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
*
* The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
* a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
* is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
* and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
* 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
*
* This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
*/
static int
XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
{
int xbuffers;
xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
if (xbuffers > (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ))
xbuffers = (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ);
if (xbuffers < 8)
xbuffers = 8;
return xbuffers;
}
/*
* GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
*/
bool
check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
{
/*
* -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
*/
if (*newval == -1)
{
/*
* If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
* be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
*/
if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
return true;
/* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
*newval = XLOGChooseNumBuffers();
}
/*
* We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL
* 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
* the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
* minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
* helpful.)
*/
if (*newval < 4)
*newval = 4;
return true;
}
/*
* Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
*
* This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
* unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists. As there's no
* usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
* control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
* will then copy it to shared memory later.
*
* reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
* reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
*/
void
LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
{
Assert(reset || ControlFile == NULL);
ControlFile = palloc(sizeof(ControlFileData));
ReadControlFile();
}
/*
* Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
*/
Size
XLOGShmemSize(void)
{
Size size;
/*
* If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
* This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
* NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
* value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
*/
if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
{
char buf[32];
snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER, PGC_S_OVERRIDE);
}
Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
/* XLogCtl */
size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
/* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
/* xlblocks array */
size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(XLogRecPtr), XLOGbuffers));
/* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
size = add_size(size, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
/* and the buffers themselves */
size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
/*
* Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
* added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores. This lets us use this
* routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
*/
return size;
}
void
XLOGShmemInit(void)
{
bool foundCFile,
foundXLog;
char *allocptr;
int i;
ControlFileData *localControlFile;
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
/*
* Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
* "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
* an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
*/
if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
{
walDebugCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(TopMemoryContext,
"WAL Debug",
ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(walDebugCxt, true);
}
#endif
XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
localControlFile = ControlFile;
ControlFile = (ControlFileData *)
ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
{
/* both should be present or neither */
Assert(foundCFile && foundXLog);
/* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks;
if (localControlFile)
pfree(localControlFile);
return;
}
memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
/*
* Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
* contents into shared memory.
*/
if (localControlFile)
{
memcpy(ControlFile, localControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
pfree(localControlFile);
}
/*
* Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
* multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
* needed here.
*/
allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
XLogCtl->xlblocks = (XLogRecPtr *) allocptr;
memset(XLogCtl->xlblocks, 0, sizeof(XLogRecPtr) * XLOGbuffers);
allocptr += sizeof(XLogRecPtr) * XLOGbuffers;
/* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
((uintptr_t) allocptr) % sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded);
WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks =
(WALInsertLockPadded *) allocptr;
allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) * NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
{
LWLockInitialize(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LWTRANCHE_WAL_INSERT);
WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
}
/*
* Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
* This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
* required for O_DIRECT.
*/
allocptr = (char *) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, allocptr);
XLogCtl->pages = allocptr;
memset(XLogCtl->pages, 0, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ * XLOGbuffers);
/*
* Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
* in additional info.)
*/
XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck = XLOGbuffers - 1;
XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
XLogCtl->SharedHotStandbyActive = false;
XLogCtl->SharedPromoteIsTriggered = false;
XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->Insert.insertpos_lck);
SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck);
InitSharedLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
}
/*
* This func must be called ONCE on system install. It creates pg_control
* and the initial XLOG segment.
*/
void
BootStrapXLOG(void)
{
CheckPoint checkPoint;
char *buffer;
XLogPageHeader page;
XLogLongPageHeader longpage;
XLogRecord *record;
char *recptr;
bool use_existent;
uint64 sysidentifier;
struct timeval tv;
pg_crc32c crc;
/*
* Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
* We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
* field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to
* use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
* to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the
* uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
* tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
* PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can
* determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
* perhaps be useful sometimes.
*/
gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
/* First timeline ID is always 1 */
ThisTimeLineID = 1;
/* page buffer must be aligned suitably for O_DIRECT */
buffer = (char *) palloc(XLOG_BLCKSZ + XLOG_BLCKSZ);
page = (XLogPageHeader) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, buffer);
memset(page, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
/*
* Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
*
* The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
* segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
* used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
*/
checkPoint.redo = wal_segment_size + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
checkPoint.nextXid =
FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(0, FirstNormalTransactionId);
checkPoint.nextOid = FirstBootstrapObjectId;
checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 0;
checkPoint.oldestXid = FirstNormalTransactionId;
checkPoint.oldestXidDB = TemplateDbOid;
checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = TemplateDbOid;
checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0;
MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB, true);
SetCommitTsLimit(InvalidTransactionId, InvalidTransactionId);
/* Set up the XLOG page header */
page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
page->xlp_tli = ThisTimeLineID;
page->xlp_pageaddr = wal_segment_size;
longpage = (XLogLongPageHeader) page;
longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
/* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
record->xl_prev = 0;
record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
record->xl_info = XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN;
record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
recptr += SizeOfXLogRecord;
/* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
*(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
*(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
INIT_CRC32C(crc);
COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
FIN_CRC32C(crc);
record->xl_crc = crc;
/* Create first XLOG segment file */
use_existent = false;
openLogFile = XLogFileInit(1, &use_existent, false);
/*
* We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
* close the file again in a moment.
*/
/* Write the first page with the initial record */
errno = 0;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_WRITE);
if (write(openLogFile, page, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
{
/* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
if (errno == 0)
errno = ENOSPC;
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_SYNC);
if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
openLogFile = -1;
/* Now create pg_control */
InitControlFile(sysidentifier);
ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
/* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
WriteControlFile();
/* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
BootStrapCLOG();
BootStrapCommitTs();
BootStrapSUBTRANS();
BootStrapMultiXact();
pfree(buffer);
/*
* Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
* otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
*/
ReadControlFile();
}
static char *
str_time(pg_time_t tnow)
{
static char buf[128];
pg_strftime(buf, sizeof(buf),
"%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
pg_localtime(&tnow, log_timezone));
return buf;
}
/*
* See if there are any recovery signal files and if so, set state for
* recovery.
*
* See if there is a recovery command file (recovery.conf), and if so
* throw an ERROR since as of PG12 we no longer recognize that.
*/
static void
readRecoverySignalFile(void)
{
struct stat stat_buf;
if (IsBootstrapProcessingMode())
return;
/*
* Check for old recovery API file: recovery.conf
*/
if (stat(RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("using recovery command file \"%s\" is not supported",
RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE)));
/*
* Remove unused .done file, if present. Ignore if absent.
*/
unlink(RECOVERY_COMMAND_DONE);
/*
* Check for recovery signal files and if found, fsync them since they
* represent server state information. We don't sweat too much about the
* possibility of fsync failure, however.
*
* If present, standby signal file takes precedence. If neither is present
* then we won't enter archive recovery.
*/
if (stat(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0)
{
int fd;
fd = BasicOpenFilePerm(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method),
S_IRUSR | S_IWUSR);
if (fd >= 0)
{
(void) pg_fsync(fd);
close(fd);
}
standby_signal_file_found = true;
}
else if (stat(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0)
{
int fd;
fd = BasicOpenFilePerm(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method),
S_IRUSR | S_IWUSR);
if (fd >= 0)
{
(void) pg_fsync(fd);
close(fd);
}
recovery_signal_file_found = true;
}
StandbyModeRequested = false;
ArchiveRecoveryRequested = false;
if (standby_signal_file_found)
{
StandbyModeRequested = true;
ArchiveRecoveryRequested = true;
}
else if (recovery_signal_file_found)
{
StandbyModeRequested = false;
ArchiveRecoveryRequested = true;
}
else
return;
/*
* We don't support standby mode in standalone backends; that requires
* other processes such as the WAL receiver to be alive.
*/
if (StandbyModeRequested && !IsUnderPostmaster)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
errmsg("standby mode is not supported by single-user servers")));
}
static void
validateRecoveryParameters(void)
{
if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
return;
/*
* Check for compulsory parameters
*/
if (StandbyModeRequested)
{
if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) &&
(recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0))
ereport(WARNING,
(errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"),
errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there.")));
}
else
{
if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL ||
strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled")));
}
/*
* Override any inconsistent requests. Note that this is a change of
* behaviour in 9.5; prior to this we simply ignored a request to pause if
* hot_standby = off, which was surprising behaviour.
*/
if (recoveryTargetAction == RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE &&
!EnableHotStandby)
recoveryTargetAction = RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_SHUTDOWN;
/*
* Final parsing of recovery_target_time string; see also
* check_recovery_target_time().
*/
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME)
{
recoveryTargetTime = DatumGetTimestampTz(DirectFunctionCall3(timestamptz_in,
CStringGetDatum(recovery_target_time_string),
ObjectIdGetDatum(InvalidOid),
Int32GetDatum(-1)));
}
/*
* If user specified recovery_target_timeline, validate it or compute the
* "latest" value. We can't do this until after we've gotten the restore
* command and set InArchiveRecovery, because we need to fetch timeline
* history files from the archive.
*/
if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_NUMERIC)
{
TimeLineID rtli = recoveryTargetTLIRequested;
/* Timeline 1 does not have a history file, all else should */
if (rtli != 1 && !existsTimeLineHistory(rtli))
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
errmsg("recovery target timeline %u does not exist",
rtli)));
recoveryTargetTLI = rtli;
}
else if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST)
{
/* We start the "latest" search from pg_control's timeline */
recoveryTargetTLI = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI);
}
else
{
/*
* else we just use the recoveryTargetTLI as already read from
* ControlFile
*/
Assert(recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_CONTROLFILE);
}
}
/*
* Exit archive-recovery state
*/
static void
exitArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
XLogSegNo endLogSegNo;
XLogSegNo startLogSegNo;
/* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
Assert(endTLI != ThisTimeLineID);
/*
* We are no longer in archive recovery state.
*/
InArchiveRecovery = false;
/*
* Update min recovery point one last time.
*/
UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
/*
* If the ending log segment is still open, close it (to avoid problems on
* Windows with trying to rename or delete an open file).
*/
if (readFile >= 0)
{
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
}
/*
* Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
* on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
* they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
* boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
*/
XLByteToPrevSeg(endOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLByteToSeg(endOfLog, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
/*
* Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
* happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
* of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
* on the new timeline.
*/
if (endLogSegNo == startLogSegNo)
{
/*
* Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
*
* Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
* considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
* avoid emplacing a bogus file.
*/
XLogFileCopy(endLogSegNo, endTLI, endLogSegNo,
XLogSegmentOffset(endOfLog, wal_segment_size));
}
else
{
/*
* The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
* segment on the new timeline.
*/
bool use_existent = true;
int fd;
fd = XLogFileInit(startLogSegNo, &use_existent, true);
if (close(fd) != 0)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
int save_errno = errno;
XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, startLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
}
}
/*
* Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
* for the new segment.
*/
XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLogArchiveCleanup(xlogfname);
/*
* Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't accidentally
* re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
*/
if (standby_signal_file_found)
durable_unlink(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
if (recovery_signal_file_found)
durable_unlink(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
}
/*
* Extract timestamp from WAL record.
*
* If the record contains a timestamp, returns true, and saves the timestamp
* in *recordXtime. If the record type has no timestamp, returns false.
* Currently, only transaction commit/abort records and restore points contain
* timestamps.
*/
static bool
getRecordTimestamp(XLogReaderState *record, TimestampTz *recordXtime)
{
uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
uint8 xact_info = info & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK;
uint8 rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record);
if (rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
{
*recordXtime = ((xl_restore_point *) XLogRecGetData(record))->rp_time;
return true;
}
if (rmid == RM_XACT_ID && (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED))
{
*recordXtime = ((xl_xact_commit *) XLogRecGetData(record))->xact_time;
return true;
}
if (rmid == RM_XACT_ID && (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED))
{
*recordXtime = ((xl_xact_abort *) XLogRecGetData(record))->xact_time;
return true;
}
return false;
}
/*
* For point-in-time recovery, this function decides whether we want to
* stop applying the XLOG before the current record.
*
* Returns true if we are stopping, false otherwise. If stopping, some
* information is saved in recoveryStopXid et al for use in annotating the
* new timeline's history file.
*/
static bool
recoveryStopsBefore(XLogReaderState *record)
{
bool stopsHere = false;
uint8 xact_info;
bool isCommit;
TimestampTz recordXtime = 0;
TransactionId recordXid;
/*
* Ignore recovery target settings when not in archive recovery (meaning
* we are in crash recovery).
*/
if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
return false;
/* Check if we should stop as soon as reaching consistency */
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE && reachedConsistency)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping after reaching consistency")));
recoveryStopAfter = false;
recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId;
recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
recoveryStopTime = 0;
recoveryStopName[0] = '\0';
return true;
}
/* Check if target LSN has been reached */
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN &&
!recoveryTargetInclusive &&
record->ReadRecPtr >= recoveryTargetLSN)
{
recoveryStopAfter = false;
recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId;
recoveryStopLSN = record->ReadRecPtr;
recoveryStopTime = 0;
recoveryStopName[0] = '\0';
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping before WAL location (LSN) \"%X/%X\"",
(uint32) (recoveryStopLSN >> 32),
(uint32) recoveryStopLSN)));
return true;
}
/* Otherwise we only consider stopping before COMMIT or ABORT records. */
if (XLogRecGetRmid(record) != RM_XACT_ID)
return false;
xact_info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK;
if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT)
{
isCommit = true;
recordXid = XLogRecGetXid(record);
}
else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED)
{
xl_xact_commit *xlrec = (xl_xact_commit *) XLogRecGetData(record);
xl_xact_parsed_commit parsed;
isCommit = true;
ParseCommitRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record),
xlrec,
&parsed);
recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid;
}
else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT)
{
isCommit = false;
recordXid = XLogRecGetXid(record);
}
else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED)
{
xl_xact_abort *xlrec = (xl_xact_abort *) XLogRecGetData(record);
xl_xact_parsed_abort parsed;
isCommit = true;
ParseAbortRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record),
xlrec,
&parsed);
recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid;
}
else
return false;
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID && !recoveryTargetInclusive)
{
/*
* There can be only one transaction end record with this exact
* transactionid
*
* when testing for an xid, we MUST test for equality only, since
* transactions are numbered in the order they start, not the order
* they complete. A higher numbered xid will complete before you about
* 50% of the time...
*/
stopsHere = (recordXid == recoveryTargetXid);
}
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME &&
getRecordTimestamp(record, &recordXtime))
{
/*
* There can be many transactions that share the same commit time, so
* we stop after the last one, if we are inclusive, or stop at the
* first one if we are exclusive
*/
if (recoveryTargetInclusive)
stopsHere = (recordXtime > recoveryTargetTime);
else
stopsHere = (recordXtime >= recoveryTargetTime);
}
if (stopsHere)
{
recoveryStopAfter = false;
recoveryStopXid = recordXid;
recoveryStopTime = recordXtime;
recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
recoveryStopName[0] = '\0';
if (isCommit)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping before commit of transaction %u, time %s",
recoveryStopXid,
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime))));
}
else
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping before abort of transaction %u, time %s",
recoveryStopXid,
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime))));
}
}
return stopsHere;
}
/*
* Same as recoveryStopsBefore, but called after applying the record.
*
* We also track the timestamp of the latest applied COMMIT/ABORT
* record in XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime.
*/
static bool
recoveryStopsAfter(XLogReaderState *record)
{
uint8 info;
uint8 xact_info;
uint8 rmid;
TimestampTz recordXtime;
/*
* Ignore recovery target settings when not in archive recovery (meaning
* we are in crash recovery).
*/
if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
return false;
info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record);
/*
* There can be many restore points that share the same name; we stop at
* the first one.
*/
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_NAME &&
rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
{
xl_restore_point *recordRestorePointData;
recordRestorePointData = (xl_restore_point *) XLogRecGetData(record);
if (strcmp(recordRestorePointData->rp_name, recoveryTargetName) == 0)
{
recoveryStopAfter = true;
recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId;
recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
(void) getRecordTimestamp(record, &recoveryStopTime);
strlcpy(recoveryStopName, recordRestorePointData->rp_name, MAXFNAMELEN);
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping at restore point \"%s\", time %s",
recoveryStopName,
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime))));
return true;
}
}
/* Check if the target LSN has been reached */
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN &&
recoveryTargetInclusive &&
record->ReadRecPtr >= recoveryTargetLSN)
{
recoveryStopAfter = true;
recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId;
recoveryStopLSN = record->ReadRecPtr;
recoveryStopTime = 0;
recoveryStopName[0] = '\0';
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping after WAL location (LSN) \"%X/%X\"",
(uint32) (recoveryStopLSN >> 32),
(uint32) recoveryStopLSN)));
return true;
}
if (rmid != RM_XACT_ID)
return false;
xact_info = info & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK;
if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED)
{
TransactionId recordXid;
/* Update the last applied transaction timestamp */
if (getRecordTimestamp(record, &recordXtime))
SetLatestXTime(recordXtime);
/* Extract the XID of the committed/aborted transaction */
if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED)
{
xl_xact_commit *xlrec = (xl_xact_commit *) XLogRecGetData(record);
xl_xact_parsed_commit parsed;
ParseCommitRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record),
xlrec,
&parsed);
recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid;
}
else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED)
{
xl_xact_abort *xlrec = (xl_xact_abort *) XLogRecGetData(record);
xl_xact_parsed_abort parsed;
ParseAbortRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record),
xlrec,
&parsed);
recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid;
}
else
recordXid = XLogRecGetXid(record);
/*
* There can be only one transaction end record with this exact
* transactionid
*
* when testing for an xid, we MUST test for equality only, since
* transactions are numbered in the order they start, not the order
* they complete. A higher numbered xid will complete before you about
* 50% of the time...
*/
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID && recoveryTargetInclusive &&
recordXid == recoveryTargetXid)
{
recoveryStopAfter = true;
recoveryStopXid = recordXid;
recoveryStopTime = recordXtime;
recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
recoveryStopName[0] = '\0';
if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping after commit of transaction %u, time %s",
recoveryStopXid,
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime))));
}
else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT ||
xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping after abort of transaction %u, time %s",
recoveryStopXid,
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime))));
}
return true;
}
}
/* Check if we should stop as soon as reaching consistency */
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE && reachedConsistency)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery stopping after reaching consistency")));
recoveryStopAfter = true;
recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId;
recoveryStopTime = 0;
recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
recoveryStopName[0] = '\0';
return true;
}
return false;
}
/*
* Wait until shared recoveryPause flag is cleared.
*
* endOfRecovery is true if the recovery target is reached and
* the paused state starts at the end of recovery because of
* recovery_target_action=pause, and false otherwise.
*
* XXX Could also be done with shared latch, avoiding the pg_usleep loop.
* Probably not worth the trouble though. This state shouldn't be one that
* anyone cares about server power consumption in.
*/
static void
recoveryPausesHere(bool endOfRecovery)
{
/* Don't pause unless users can connect! */
if (!LocalHotStandbyActive)
return;
/* Don't pause after standby promotion has been triggered */
if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered)
return;
if (endOfRecovery)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("pausing at the end of recovery"),
errhint("Execute pg_wal_replay_resume() to promote.")));
else
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("recovery has paused"),
errhint("Execute pg_wal_replay_resume() to continue.")));
while (RecoveryIsPaused())
{
HandleStartupProcInterrupts();
if (CheckForStandbyTrigger())
return;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_PAUSE);
pg_usleep(1000000L); /* 1000 ms */
pgstat_report_wait_end();
}
}
bool
RecoveryIsPaused(void)
{
bool recoveryPause;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
recoveryPause = XLogCtl->recoveryPause;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return recoveryPause;
}
void
SetRecoveryPause(bool recoveryPause)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->recoveryPause = recoveryPause;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* When recovery_min_apply_delay is set, we wait long enough to make sure
* certain record types are applied at least that interval behind the primary.
*
* Returns true if we waited.
*
* Note that the delay is calculated between the WAL record log time and
* the current time on standby. We would prefer to keep track of when this
* standby received each WAL record, which would allow a more consistent
* approach and one not affected by time synchronisation issues, but that
* is significantly more effort and complexity for little actual gain in
* usability.
*/
static bool
recoveryApplyDelay(XLogReaderState *record)
{
uint8 xact_info;
TimestampTz xtime;
TimestampTz delayUntil;
long secs;
int microsecs;
/* nothing to do if no delay configured */
if (recovery_min_apply_delay <= 0)
return false;
/* no delay is applied on a database not yet consistent */
if (!reachedConsistency)
return false;
/* nothing to do if crash recovery is requested */
if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
return false;
/*
* Is it a COMMIT record?
*
* We deliberately choose not to delay aborts since they have no effect on
* MVCC. We already allow replay of records that don't have a timestamp,
* so there is already opportunity for issues caused by early conflicts on
* standbys.
*/
if (XLogRecGetRmid(record) != RM_XACT_ID)
return false;
xact_info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK;
if (xact_info != XLOG_XACT_COMMIT &&
xact_info != XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED)
return false;
if (!getRecordTimestamp(record, &xtime))
return false;
delayUntil = TimestampTzPlusMilliseconds(xtime, recovery_min_apply_delay);
/*
* Exit without arming the latch if it's already past time to apply this
* record
*/
TimestampDifference(GetCurrentTimestamp(), delayUntil, &secs, &microsecs);
if (secs <= 0 && microsecs <= 0)
return false;
while (true)
{
ResetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
/* might change the trigger file's location */
HandleStartupProcInterrupts();
if (CheckForStandbyTrigger())
break;
/*
* Wait for difference between GetCurrentTimestamp() and delayUntil
*/
TimestampDifference(GetCurrentTimestamp(), delayUntil,
&secs, &microsecs);
/*
* NB: We're ignoring waits below recovery_min_apply_delay's
* resolution.
*/
if (secs <= 0 && microsecs / 1000 <= 0)
break;
elog(DEBUG2, "recovery apply delay %ld seconds, %d milliseconds",
secs, microsecs / 1000);
(void) WaitLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch,
WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH,
secs * 1000L + microsecs / 1000,
WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_APPLY_DELAY);
}
return true;
}
/*
* Save timestamp of latest processed commit/abort record.
*
* We keep this in XLogCtl, not a simple static variable, so that it can be
* seen by processes other than the startup process. Note in particular
* that CreateRestartPoint is executed in the checkpointer.
*/
static void
SetLatestXTime(TimestampTz xtime)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime = xtime;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* Fetch timestamp of latest processed commit/abort record.
*/
TimestampTz
GetLatestXTime(void)
{
TimestampTz xtime;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
xtime = XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return xtime;
}
/*
* Save timestamp of the next chunk of WAL records to apply.
*
* We keep this in XLogCtl, not a simple static variable, so that it can be
* seen by all backends.
*/
static void
SetCurrentChunkStartTime(TimestampTz xtime)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->currentChunkStartTime = xtime;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* Fetch timestamp of latest processed commit/abort record.
* Startup process maintains an accurate local copy in XLogReceiptTime
*/
TimestampTz
GetCurrentChunkReplayStartTime(void)
{
TimestampTz xtime;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
xtime = XLogCtl->currentChunkStartTime;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return xtime;
}
/*
* Returns time of receipt of current chunk of XLOG data, as well as
* whether it was received from streaming replication or from archives.
*/
void
GetXLogReceiptTime(TimestampTz *rtime, bool *fromStream)
{
/*
* This must be executed in the startup process, since we don't export the
* relevant state to shared memory.
*/
Assert(InRecovery);
*rtime = XLogReceiptTime;
*fromStream = (XLogReceiptSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM);
}
/*
* Note that text field supplied is a parameter name and does not require
* translation
*/
#define RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(param_name, currValue, minValue) \
do { \
if ((currValue) < (minValue)) \
ereport(ERROR, \
(errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), \
errmsg("hot standby is not possible because %s = %d is a lower setting than on the primary server (its value was %d)", \
param_name, \
currValue, \
minValue))); \
} while(0)
/*
* Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
* for various aspects of recovery operation.
*
* Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
* listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
* If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
*/
static void
CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
{
/*
* For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
* wal_level.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && ControlFile->wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL)
{
ereport(WARNING,
(errmsg("WAL was generated with wal_level=minimal, data may be missing"),
errhint("This happens if you temporarily set wal_level=minimal without taking a new base backup.")));
}
/*
* For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
* must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
{
if (ControlFile->wal_level < WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA)
ereport(ERROR,
(errmsg("hot standby is not possible because wal_level was not set to \"replica\" or higher on the primary server"),
errhint("Either set wal_level to \"replica\" on the primary, or turn off hot_standby here.")));
/* We ignore autovacuum_max_workers when we make this test. */
RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
MaxConnections,
ControlFile->MaxConnections);
RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
max_worker_processes,
ControlFile->max_worker_processes);
RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
max_wal_senders,
ControlFile->max_wal_senders);
RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
max_prepared_xacts,
ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts);
RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
max_locks_per_xact,
ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact);
}
}
/*
* This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
*/
void
StartupXLOG(void)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert;
CheckPoint checkPoint;
bool wasShutdown;
bool reachedRecoveryTarget = false;
bool haveBackupLabel = false;
bool haveTblspcMap = false;
XLogRecPtr RecPtr,
checkPointLoc,
EndOfLog;
TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI;
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID;
XLogRecord *record;
TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
bool backupEndRequired = false;
bool backupFromStandby = false;
DBState dbstate_at_startup;
XLogReaderState *xlogreader;
XLogPageReadPrivate private;
bool promoted = false;
struct stat st;
/*
* We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
* be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
*/
Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
/*
* Check that contents look valid.
*/
if (!XRecOffIsValid(ControlFile->checkPoint))
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
switch (ControlFile->state)
{
case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
/*
* This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
* mode
*/
ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
(errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
str_time(ControlFile->time))));
break;
case DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
str_time(ControlFile->time))));
break;
case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
str_time(ControlFile->time))));
break;
case DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
str_time(ControlFile->time)),
errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
" you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
break;
case DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
str_time(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.time)),
errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
" and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
break;
case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
str_time(ControlFile->time))));
break;
default:
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
}
/* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
#ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED)
pg_usleep(60000000L);
#endif
/*
* Verify that pg_wal and pg_wal/archive_status exist. In cases where
* someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories may have been
* excluded and need to be re-created.
*/
ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure();
/*----------
* If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
*
* - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
* used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
* bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync
* this temporary data.
*
* - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
* which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure in
* the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
* though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
* persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
*/
if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED &&
ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY)
{
RemoveTempXlogFiles();
SyncDataDirectory();
}
/*
* Initialize on the assumption we want to recover to the latest timeline
* that's active according to pg_control.
*/
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI >
ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID)
recoveryTargetTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
else
recoveryTargetTLI = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
/*
* Check for signal files, and if so set up state for offline recovery
*/
readRecoverySignalFile();
validateRecoveryParameters();
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
{
if (StandbyModeRequested)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("entering standby mode")));
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to XID %u",
recoveryTargetXid)));
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to %s",
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryTargetTime))));
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_NAME)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to \"%s\"",
recoveryTargetName)));
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to WAL location (LSN) \"%X/%X\"",
(uint32) (recoveryTargetLSN >> 32),
(uint32) recoveryTargetLSN)));
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to earliest consistent point")));
else
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("starting archive recovery")));
}
/*
* Take ownership of the wakeup latch if we're going to sleep during
* recovery.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
OwnLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
/* Set up XLOG reader facility */
MemSet(&private, 0, sizeof(XLogPageReadPrivate));
xlogreader =
XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL,
XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = &XLogPageRead,
.segment_open = NULL,
.segment_close = wal_segment_close),
&private);
if (!xlogreader)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OUT_OF_MEMORY),
errmsg("out of memory"),
errdetail("Failed while allocating a WAL reading processor.")));
xlogreader->system_identifier = ControlFile->system_identifier;
/*
* Allocate two page buffers dedicated to WAL consistency checks. We do
* it this way, rather than just making static arrays, for two reasons:
* (1) no need to waste the storage in most instantiations of the backend;
* (2) a static char array isn't guaranteed to have any particular
* alignment, whereas palloc() will provide MAXALIGN'd storage.
*/
replay_image_masked = (char *) palloc(BLCKSZ);
primary_image_masked = (char *) palloc(BLCKSZ);
if (read_backup_label(&checkPointLoc, &backupEndRequired,
&backupFromStandby))
{
List *tablespaces = NIL;
/*
* Archive recovery was requested, and thanks to the backup label
* file, we know how far we need to replay to reach consistency. Enter
* archive recovery directly.
*/
InArchiveRecovery = true;
if (StandbyModeRequested)
StandbyMode = true;
/*
* When a backup_label file is present, we want to roll forward from
* the checkpoint it identifies, rather than using pg_control.
*/
record = ReadCheckpointRecord(xlogreader, checkPointLoc, 0, true);
if (record != NULL)
{
memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(CheckPoint));
wasShutdown = ((record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK) == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN);
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("checkpoint record is at %X/%X",
(uint32) (checkPointLoc >> 32), (uint32) checkPointLoc)));
InRecovery = true; /* force recovery even if SHUTDOWNED */
/*
* Make sure that REDO location exists. This may not be the case
* if there was a crash during an online backup, which left a
* backup_label around that references a WAL segment that's
* already been archived.
*/
if (checkPoint.redo < checkPointLoc)
{
XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, checkPoint.redo);
if (!ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, false))
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("could not find redo location referenced by checkpoint record"),
errhint("If you are restoring from a backup, touch \"%s/recovery.signal\" and add required recovery options.\n"
"If you are not restoring from a backup, try removing the file \"%s/backup_label\".\n"
"Be careful: removing \"%s/backup_label\" will result in a corrupt cluster if restoring from a backup.",
DataDir, DataDir, DataDir)));
}
}
else
{
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("could not locate required checkpoint record"),
errhint("If you are restoring from a backup, touch \"%s/recovery.signal\" and add required recovery options.\n"
"If you are not restoring from a backup, try removing the file \"%s/backup_label\".\n"
"Be careful: removing \"%s/backup_label\" will result in a corrupt cluster if restoring from a backup.",
DataDir, DataDir, DataDir)));
wasShutdown = false; /* keep compiler quiet */
}
/* read the tablespace_map file if present and create symlinks. */
if (read_tablespace_map(&tablespaces))
{
ListCell *lc;
foreach(lc, tablespaces)
{
tablespaceinfo *ti = lfirst(lc);
char *linkloc;
linkloc = psprintf("pg_tblspc/%s", ti->oid);
/*
* Remove the existing symlink if any and Create the symlink
* under PGDATA.
*/
remove_tablespace_symlink(linkloc);
if (symlink(ti->path, linkloc) < 0)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
linkloc)));
pfree(ti->oid);
pfree(ti->path);
pfree(ti);
}
/* set flag to delete it later */
haveTblspcMap = true;
}
/* set flag to delete it later */
haveBackupLabel = true;
}
else
{
/*
* If tablespace_map file is present without backup_label file, there
* is no use of such file. There is no harm in retaining it, but it
* is better to get rid of the map file so that we don't have any
* redundant file in data directory and it will avoid any sort of
* confusion. It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of
* the way rather than delete it completely, also we ignore any error
* that occurs in rename operation as even if map file is present
* without backup_label file, it is harmless.
*/
if (stat(TABLESPACE_MAP, &st) == 0)
{
unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
if (durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, DEBUG1) == 0)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("ignoring file \"%s\" because no file \"%s\" exists",
TABLESPACE_MAP, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE),
errdetail("File \"%s\" was renamed to \"%s\".",
TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD)));
else
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("ignoring file \"%s\" because no file \"%s\" exists",
TABLESPACE_MAP, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE),
errdetail("Could not rename file \"%s\" to \"%s\": %m.",
TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD)));
}
/*
* It's possible that archive recovery was requested, but we don't
* know how far we need to replay the WAL before we reach consistency.
* This can happen for example if a base backup is taken from a
* running server using an atomic filesystem snapshot, without calling
* pg_start/stop_backup. Or if you just kill a running primary server
* and put it into archive recovery by creating a recovery signal
* file.
*
* Our strategy in that case is to perform crash recovery first,
* replaying all the WAL present in pg_wal, and only enter archive
* recovery after that.
*
* But usually we already know how far we need to replay the WAL (up
* to minRecoveryPoint, up to backupEndPoint, or until we see an
* end-of-backup record), and we can enter archive recovery directly.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
(ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr ||
ControlFile->backupEndRequired ||
ControlFile->backupEndPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr ||
ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED))
{
InArchiveRecovery = true;
if (StandbyModeRequested)
StandbyMode = true;
}
/* Get the last valid checkpoint record. */
checkPointLoc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
RedoStartLSN = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
record = ReadCheckpointRecord(xlogreader, checkPointLoc, 1, true);
if (record != NULL)
{
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("checkpoint record is at %X/%X",
(uint32) (checkPointLoc >> 32), (uint32) checkPointLoc)));
}
else
{
/*
* We used to attempt to go back to a secondary checkpoint record
* here, but only when not in standby mode. We now just fail if we
* can't read the last checkpoint because this allows us to
* simplify processing around checkpoints.
*/
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("could not locate a valid checkpoint record")));
}
memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(CheckPoint));
wasShutdown = ((record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK) == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN);
}
/*
* Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do
* any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
* being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them
* in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
* safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
* first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all
* directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
* after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
* backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
* symlinks.
*/
RelationCacheInitFileRemove();
/*
* If the location of the checkpoint record is not on the expected
* timeline in the history of the requested timeline, we cannot proceed:
* the backup is not part of the history of the requested timeline.
*/
Assert(expectedTLEs); /* was initialized by reading checkpoint
* record */
if (tliOfPointInHistory(checkPointLoc, expectedTLEs) !=
checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID)
{
XLogRecPtr switchpoint;
/*
* tliSwitchPoint will throw an error if the checkpoint's timeline is
* not in expectedTLEs at all.
*/
switchpoint = tliSwitchPoint(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID, expectedTLEs, NULL);
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("requested timeline %u is not a child of this server's history",
recoveryTargetTLI),
errdetail("Latest checkpoint is at %X/%X on timeline %u, but in the history of the requested timeline, the server forked off from that timeline at %X/%X.",
(uint32) (ControlFile->checkPoint >> 32),
(uint32) ControlFile->checkPoint,
ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID,
(uint32) (switchpoint >> 32),
(uint32) switchpoint)));
}
/*
* The min recovery point should be part of the requested timeline's
* history, too.
*/
if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint) &&
tliOfPointInHistory(ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint - 1, expectedTLEs) !=
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("requested timeline %u does not contain minimum recovery point %X/%X on timeline %u",
recoveryTargetTLI,
(uint32) (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint >> 32),
(uint32) ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint,
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI)));
LastRec = RecPtr = checkPointLoc;
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("redo record is at %X/%X; shutdown %s",
(uint32) (checkPoint.redo >> 32), (uint32) checkPoint.redo,
wasShutdown ? "true" : "false")));
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("next transaction ID: " UINT64_FORMAT "; next OID: %u",
U64FromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid),
checkPoint.nextOid)));
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("next MultiXactId: %u; next MultiXactOffset: %u",
checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset)));
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("oldest unfrozen transaction ID: %u, in database %u",
checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB)));
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("oldest MultiXactId: %u, in database %u",
checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB)));
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg_internal("commit timestamp Xid oldest/newest: %u/%u",
checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid,
checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid)));
if (!TransactionIdIsNormal(XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid)))
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("invalid next transaction ID")));
/* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0;
MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB, true);
SetCommitTsLimit(checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid,
checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
/*
* Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
* required resources.
*/
StartupReplicationSlots();
/*
* Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
* during crash recovery.
*/
StartupReorderBuffer();
/*
* Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
* truncations.
*/
StartupMultiXact();
/*
* Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is
* enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
* timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be
* started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
*/
if (ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
StartupCommitTs();
/*
* Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
*/
StartupReplicationOrigin();
/*
* Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
* control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
* the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
*/
if (ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED)
XLogCtl->unloggedLSN = ControlFile->unloggedLSN;
else
XLogCtl->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN;
/*
* We must replay WAL entries using the same TimeLineID they were created
* under, so temporarily adopt the TLI indicated by the checkpoint (see
* also xlog_redo()).
*/
ThisTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
/*
* Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
* target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
* ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
* the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
* might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
* server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all the
* history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can use
* one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files are
* small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them and
* regret later.
*/
restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI);
/*
* Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
* be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before
* taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
* are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
* replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
* of the on-disk two-phase data.
*/
restoreTwoPhaseData();
lastFullPageWrites = checkPoint.fullPageWrites;
RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
doPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
if (RecPtr < checkPoint.redo)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("invalid redo in checkpoint record")));
/*
* Check whether we need to force recovery from WAL. If it appears to
* have been a clean shutdown and we did not have a recovery signal file,
* then assume no recovery needed.
*/
if (checkPoint.redo < RecPtr)
{
if (wasShutdown)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("invalid redo record in shutdown checkpoint")));
InRecovery = true;
}
else if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED)
InRecovery = true;
else if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
{
/* force recovery due to presence of recovery signal file */
InRecovery = true;
}
/* REDO */
if (InRecovery)
{
int rmid;
/*
* Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
* selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
* pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
* backup history file.
*/
dbstate_at_startup = ControlFile->state;
if (InArchiveRecovery)
{
ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
else
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("database system was not properly shut down; "
"automatic recovery in progress")));
if (recoveryTargetTLI > ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("crash recovery starts in timeline %u "
"and has target timeline %u",
ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID,
recoveryTargetTLI)));
ControlFile->state = DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPointLoc;
ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
if (InArchiveRecovery)
{
/* initialize minRecoveryPoint if not set yet */
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < checkPoint.redo)
{
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = checkPoint.redo;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
}
}
/*
* Set backupStartPoint if we're starting recovery from a base backup.
*
* Also set backupEndPoint and use minRecoveryPoint as the backup end
* location if we're starting recovery from a base backup which was
* taken from a standby. In this case, the database system status in
* pg_control must indicate that the database was already in recovery.
* Usually that will be DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY but also can be
* DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY if recovery previously was interrupted
* before reaching this point; e.g. because restore_command or
* primary_conninfo were faulty.
*
* Any other state indicates that the backup somehow became corrupted
* and we can't sensibly continue with recovery.
*/
if (haveBackupLabel)
{
ControlFile->backupStartPoint = checkPoint.redo;
ControlFile->backupEndRequired = backupEndRequired;
if (backupFromStandby)
{
if (dbstate_at_startup != DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY &&
dbstate_at_startup != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("backup_label contains data inconsistent with control file"),
errhint("This means that the backup is corrupted and you will "
"have to use another backup for recovery.")));
ControlFile->backupEndPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
}
}
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
/* No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough */
UpdateControlFile();
/*
* Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash
* recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in
* the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
* control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However,
* if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
* is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
* startup process to think that there are still invalid page
* references when checking for data consistency.
*/
if (InArchiveRecovery)
{
minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
}
else
{
minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
minRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
}
/*
* Reset pgstat data, because it may be invalid after recovery.
*/
pgstat_reset_all();
/*
* If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
* has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the
* label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
* the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
* to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename
* the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
*/
if (haveBackupLabel)
{
unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD);
durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, FATAL);
}
/*
* If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
* symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so
* that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
* It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
* rather than delete it completely.
*/
if (haveTblspcMap)
{
unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, FATAL);
}
/* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
CheckRequiredParameterValues();
/*
* We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
* reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
* connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
* garbage is left over from before.
*/
ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP);
/*
* Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
* behind by crashed backends.
*/
DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles();
/*
* Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
* yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
* control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
* running-xacts WAL record.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
{
TransactionId *xids;
int nxids;
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("initializing for hot standby")));
InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
if (wasShutdown)
oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
else
oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(oldestActiveXID));
/* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
ProcArrayInitRecovery(XidFromFullTransactionId(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid));
/*
* Startup commit log and subtrans only. MultiXact and commit
* timestamp have already been started up and other SLRUs are not
* maintained during recovery and need not be started yet.
*/
StartupCLOG();
StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
/*
* If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
* nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
* empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
* additional standby state for prepared transactions.
*/
if (wasShutdown)
{
RunningTransactionsData running;
TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
/*
* Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
* shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
* alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
* subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
*/
running.xcnt = nxids;
running.subxcnt = 0;
running.subxid_overflow = false;
running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
running.xids = xids;
ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
}
}
/* Initialize resource managers */
for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
{
if (RmgrTable[rmid].rm_startup != NULL)
RmgrTable[rmid].rm_startup();
}
/*
* Initialize shared variables for tracking progress of WAL replay, as
* if we had just replayed the record before the REDO location (or the
* checkpoint record itself, if it's a shutdown checkpoint).
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (checkPoint.redo < RecPtr)
XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
else
XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr = EndRecPtr;
XLogCtl->replayEndTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr = XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr;
XLogCtl->lastReplayedTLI = XLogCtl->replayEndTLI;
XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime = 0;
XLogCtl->currentChunkStartTime = 0;
XLogCtl->recoveryPause = false;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/* Also ensure XLogReceiptTime has a sane value */
XLogReceiptTime = GetCurrentTimestamp();
/*
* Let postmaster know we've started redo now, so that it can launch
* checkpointer to perform restartpoints. We don't bother during
* crash recovery as restartpoints can only be performed during
* archive recovery. And we'd like to keep crash recovery simple, to
* avoid introducing bugs that could affect you when recovering after
* crash.
*
* After this point, we can no longer assume that we're the only
* process in addition to postmaster! Also, fsync requests are
* subsequently to be handled by the checkpointer, not locally.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && IsUnderPostmaster)
{
PublishStartupProcessInformation();
EnableSyncRequestForwarding();
SendPostmasterSignal(PMSIGNAL_RECOVERY_STARTED);
bgwriterLaunched = true;
}
/*
* Allow read-only connections immediately if we're consistent
* already.
*/
CheckRecoveryConsistency();
/*
* Find the first record that logically follows the checkpoint --- it
* might physically precede it, though.
*/
if (checkPoint.redo < RecPtr)
{
/* back up to find the record */
XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, checkPoint.redo);
record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, PANIC, false);
}
else
{
/* just have to read next record after CheckPoint */
record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, false);
}
if (record != NULL)
{
ErrorContextCallback errcallback;
TimestampTz xtime;
PGRUsage ru0;
pg_rusage_init(&ru0);
InRedo = true;
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("redo starts at %X/%X",
(uint32) (ReadRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) ReadRecPtr)));
/*
* main redo apply loop
*/
do
{
bool switchedTLI = false;
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
if (XLOG_DEBUG ||
(rmid == RM_XACT_ID && trace_recovery_messages <= DEBUG2) ||
(rmid != RM_XACT_ID && trace_recovery_messages <= DEBUG3))
{
StringInfoData buf;
initStringInfo(&buf);
appendStringInfo(&buf, "REDO @ %X/%X; LSN %X/%X: ",
(uint32) (ReadRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) ReadRecPtr,
(uint32) (EndRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) EndRecPtr);
xlog_outrec(&buf, xlogreader);
appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
xlog_outdesc(&buf, xlogreader);
elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
pfree(buf.data);
}
#endif
/* Handle interrupt signals of startup process */
HandleStartupProcInterrupts();
/*
* Pause WAL replay, if requested by a hot-standby session via
* SetRecoveryPause().
*
* Note that we intentionally don't take the info_lck spinlock
* here. We might therefore read a slightly stale value of
* the recoveryPause flag, but it can't be very stale (no
* worse than the last spinlock we did acquire). Since a
* pause request is a pretty asynchronous thing anyway,
* possibly responding to it one WAL record later than we
* otherwise would is a minor issue, so it doesn't seem worth
* adding another spinlock cycle to prevent that.
*/
if (((volatile XLogCtlData *) XLogCtl)->recoveryPause)
recoveryPausesHere(false);
/*
* Have we reached our recovery target?
*/
if (recoveryStopsBefore(xlogreader))
{
reachedRecoveryTarget = true;
break;
}
/*
* If we've been asked to lag the primary, wait on latch until
* enough time has passed.
*/
if (recoveryApplyDelay(xlogreader))
{
/*
* We test for paused recovery again here. If user sets
* delayed apply, it may be because they expect to pause
* recovery in case of problems, so we must test again
* here otherwise pausing during the delay-wait wouldn't
* work.
*/
if (((volatile XLogCtlData *) XLogCtl)->recoveryPause)
recoveryPausesHere(false);
}
/* Setup error traceback support for ereport() */
errcallback.callback = rm_redo_error_callback;
errcallback.arg = (void *) xlogreader;
errcallback.previous = error_context_stack;
error_context_stack = &errcallback;
/*
* ShmemVariableCache->nextXid must be beyond record's
* xid.
*/
AdvanceNextFullTransactionIdPastXid(record->xl_xid);
/*
* Before replaying this record, check if this record causes
* the current timeline to change. The record is already
* considered to be part of the new timeline, so we update
* ThisTimeLineID before replaying it. That's important so
* that replayEndTLI, which is recorded as the minimum
* recovery point's TLI if recovery stops after this record,
* is set correctly.
*/
if (record->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID)
{
TimeLineID newTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
TimeLineID prevTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
uint8 info = record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
{
CheckPoint checkPoint;
memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(CheckPoint));
newTLI = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
prevTLI = checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID;
}
else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
{
xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
newTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
prevTLI = xlrec.PrevTimeLineID;
}
if (newTLI != ThisTimeLineID)
{
/* Check that it's OK to switch to this TLI */
checkTimeLineSwitch(EndRecPtr, newTLI, prevTLI);
/* Following WAL records should be run with new TLI */
ThisTimeLineID = newTLI;
switchedTLI = true;
}
}
/*
* Update shared replayEndRecPtr before replaying this record,
* so that XLogFlush will update minRecoveryPoint correctly.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr = EndRecPtr;
XLogCtl->replayEndTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* If we are attempting to enter Hot Standby mode, process
* XIDs we see
*/
if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED &&
TransactionIdIsValid(record->xl_xid))
RecordKnownAssignedTransactionIds(record->xl_xid);
/* Now apply the WAL record itself */
RmgrTable[record->xl_rmid].rm_redo(xlogreader);
/*
* After redo, check whether the backup pages associated with
* the WAL record are consistent with the existing pages. This
* check is done only if consistency check is enabled for this
* record.
*/
if ((record->xl_info & XLR_CHECK_CONSISTENCY) != 0)
checkXLogConsistency(xlogreader);
/* Pop the error context stack */
error_context_stack = errcallback.previous;
/*
* Update lastReplayedEndRecPtr after this record has been
* successfully replayed.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr = EndRecPtr;
XLogCtl->lastReplayedTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* If rm_redo called XLogRequestWalReceiverReply, then we wake
* up the receiver so that it notices the updated
* lastReplayedEndRecPtr and sends a reply to the primary.
*/
if (doRequestWalReceiverReply)
{
doRequestWalReceiverReply = false;
WalRcvForceReply();
}
/* Remember this record as the last-applied one */
LastRec = ReadRecPtr;
/* Allow read-only connections if we're consistent now */
CheckRecoveryConsistency();
/* Is this a timeline switch? */
if (switchedTLI)
{
/*
* Before we continue on the new timeline, clean up any
* (possibly bogus) future WAL segments on the old
* timeline.
*/
RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndRecPtr, ThisTimeLineID);
/*
* Wake up any walsenders to notice that we are on a new
* timeline.
*/
if (AllowCascadeReplication())
WalSndWakeup();
}
/* Exit loop if we reached inclusive recovery target */
if (recoveryStopsAfter(xlogreader))
{
reachedRecoveryTarget = true;
break;
}
/* Else, try to fetch the next WAL record */
record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, false);
} while (record != NULL);
/*
* end of main redo apply loop
*/
if (reachedRecoveryTarget)
{
if (!reachedConsistency)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("requested recovery stop point is before consistent recovery point")));
/*
* This is the last point where we can restart recovery with a
* new recovery target, if we shutdown and begin again. After
* this, Resource Managers may choose to do permanent
* corrective actions at end of recovery.
*/
switch (recoveryTargetAction)
{
case RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_SHUTDOWN:
/*
* exit with special return code to request shutdown
* of postmaster. Log messages issued from
* postmaster.
*/
proc_exit(3);
case RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE:
SetRecoveryPause(true);
recoveryPausesHere(true);
/* drop into promote */
case RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PROMOTE:
break;
}
}
/* Allow resource managers to do any required cleanup. */
for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
{
if (RmgrTable[rmid].rm_cleanup != NULL)
RmgrTable[rmid].rm_cleanup();
}
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("redo done at %X/%X system usage: %s",
(uint32) (ReadRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) ReadRecPtr,
pg_rusage_show(&ru0))));
xtime = GetLatestXTime();
if (xtime)
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("last completed transaction was at log time %s",
timestamptz_to_str(xtime))));
InRedo = false;
}
else
{
/* there are no WAL records following the checkpoint */
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("redo is not required")));
}
/*
* This check is intentionally after the above log messages that
* indicate how far recovery went.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
recoveryTarget != RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET &&
!reachedRecoveryTarget)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("recovery ended before configured recovery target was reached")));
}
/*
* Kill WAL receiver, if it's still running, before we continue to write
* the startup checkpoint record. It will trump over the checkpoint and
* subsequent records if it's still alive when we start writing WAL.
*/
ShutdownWalRcv();
/*
* Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
* done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
* created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
* completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
* end-of-recovery steps fail.
*/
if (InRecovery)
ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT);
/*
* We don't need the latch anymore. It's not strictly necessary to disown
* it, but let's do it for the sake of tidiness.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
DisownLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
/*
* We are now done reading the xlog from stream. Turn off streaming
* recovery to force fetching the files (which would be required at end of
* recovery, e.g., timeline history file) from archive or pg_wal.
*
* Note that standby mode must be turned off after killing WAL receiver,
* i.e., calling ShutdownWalRcv().
*/
Assert(!WalRcvStreaming());
StandbyMode = false;
/*
* Re-fetch the last valid or last applied record, so we can identify the
* exact endpoint of what we consider the valid portion of WAL.
*/
XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, LastRec);
record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, PANIC, false);
EndOfLog = EndRecPtr;
/*
* EndOfLogTLI is the TLI in the filename of the XLOG segment containing
* the end-of-log. It could be different from the timeline that EndOfLog
* nominally belongs to, if there was a timeline switch in that segment,
* and we were reading the old WAL from a segment belonging to a higher
* timeline.
*/
EndOfLogTLI = xlogreader->seg.ws_tli;
/*
* Complain if we did not roll forward far enough to render the backup
* dump consistent. Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
* minRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint might
* be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have been
* advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
*/
if (InRecovery &&
(EndOfLog < minRecoveryPoint ||
!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint)))
{
/*
* Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
* minRecoveryPoint. That's usually a bad sign, indicating that you
* tried to recover from an online backup but never called
* pg_stop_backup(), or you didn't archive all the WAL up to that
* point. However, this also happens in crash recovery, if the system
* crashes while an online backup is in progress. We must not treat
* that as an error, or the database will refuse to start up.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
{
if (ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
else if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint))
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
errhint("Online backup started with pg_start_backup() must be ended with pg_stop_backup(), and all WAL up to that point must be available at recovery.")));
else
ereport(FATAL,
(errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
}
}
/*
* Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
* This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
* as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
*/
oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(NULL, NULL);
/*
* Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
*
* If we are doing an archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This
* handles a couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL
* during recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must
* assign it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the
* current last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
* overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
* DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the
* problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
*
* In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
*/
PrevTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
{
char reason[200];
char recoveryPath[MAXPGPATH];
Assert(InArchiveRecovery);
ThisTimeLineID = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI) + 1;
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", ThisTimeLineID)));
/*
* Create a comment for the history file to explain why and where
* timeline changed.
*/
if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID)
snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason),
"%s transaction %u",
recoveryStopAfter ? "after" : "before",
recoveryStopXid);
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME)
snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason),
"%s %s\n",
recoveryStopAfter ? "after" : "before",
timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime));
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN)
snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason),
"%s LSN %X/%X\n",
recoveryStopAfter ? "after" : "before",
(uint32) (recoveryStopLSN >> 32),
(uint32) recoveryStopLSN);
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_NAME)
snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason),
"at restore point \"%s\"",
recoveryStopName);
else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE)
snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), "reached consistency");
else
snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), "no recovery target specified");
/*
* We are now done reading the old WAL. Turn off archive fetching if
* it was active, and make a writable copy of the last WAL segment.
* (Note that we also have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
* readBuf; we will use that below.)
*/
exitArchiveRecovery(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog);
/*
* Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
* point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
* will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
* servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new
* timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
* to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
* To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
* between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
*/
writeTimeLineHistory(ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI,
EndRecPtr, reason);
/*
* Since there might be a partial WAL segment named RECOVERYXLOG, get
* rid of it.
*/
snprintf(recoveryPath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/RECOVERYXLOG");
unlink(recoveryPath); /* ignore any error */
/* Get rid of any remaining recovered timeline-history file, too */
snprintf(recoveryPath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/RECOVERYHISTORY");
unlink(recoveryPath); /* ignore any error */
}
/* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
XLogCtl->ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID = PrevTimeLineID;
/*
* Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
* buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
* previous incarnation.
*/
Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
Insert->PrevBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(LastRec);
Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
/*
* Tricky point here: readBuf contains the *last* block that the LastRec
* record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the
* one we want to use.
*/
if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
{
char *page;
int len;
int firstIdx;
XLogRecPtr pageBeginPtr;
pageBeginPtr = EndOfLog - (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ);
Assert(readOff == XLogSegmentOffset(pageBeginPtr, wal_segment_size));
firstIdx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(EndOfLog);
/* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
len = EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
memcpy(page, xlogreader->readBuf, len);
memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
XLogCtl->xlblocks[firstIdx] = pageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = pageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
}
else
{
/*
* There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
* let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
* buffer.
*/
XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = EndOfLog;
}
LogwrtResult.Write = LogwrtResult.Flush = EndOfLog;
XLogCtl->LogwrtResult = LogwrtResult;
XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndOfLog;
XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = EndOfLog;
/*
* Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
* record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
* record is written.
*/
Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
UpdateFullPageWrites();
LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1;
if (InRecovery)
{
/*
* Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
*
* Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line
* one. This is not particularly critical, but since we may be
* assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have
* the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
* allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
*
* In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record
* instead of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later,
* after we're fully out of recovery mode and already accepting
* queries.
*/
if (bgwriterLaunched)
{
if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered)
{
checkPointLoc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
/*
* Confirm the last checkpoint is available for us to recover
* from if we fail.
*/
record = ReadCheckpointRecord(xlogreader, checkPointLoc, 1, false);
if (record != NULL)
{
promoted = true;
/*
* Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of
* recovery, since we aren't doing a checkpoint. That
* means that the checkpointer process may likely be in
* the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and could
* continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds
* strange, but the effect is roughly the same and it
* would be stranger to try to come out of the
* restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
* checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
*/
CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord();
}
}
if (!promoted)
RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE |
CHECKPOINT_WAIT);
}
else
CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE);
}
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
{
/*
* And finally, execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
*/
if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0)
ExecuteRecoveryCommand(recoveryEndCommand,
"recovery_end_command",
true);
/*
* We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old
* timeline.
*
* If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline,
* remove them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
* pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not
* part of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
*/
RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndOfLog, ThisTimeLineID);
/*
* If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with
* the last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive
* it, and the server that created the WAL never archives it either
* (e.g. because it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the
* archive. That's OK from our point of view, because the new segment
* that we created with the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old
* timeline up to the switch point. But if you later try to do PITR to
* the "missing" WAL on the old timeline, recovery won't find it in
* the archive. It's physically present in the new file with new TLI,
* but recovery won't look there when it's recovering to the older
* timeline. On the other hand, if we archive the partial segment, and
* the original server on that timeline is still running and archives
* the completed version of the same segment later, it will fail. (We
* used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it caused such problems).
*
* As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial
* suffix, and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read
* .partial segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd
* PITR case, the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal
* directory (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging,
* too.
*
* If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline,
* however, we had already determined that the segment is complete, so
* we can let it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was
* restored from the archive to begin with, it's expected to have a
* .done file).
*/
if (XLogSegmentOffset(EndOfLog, wal_segment_size) != 0 &&
XLogArchivingActive())
{
char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
XLogSegNo endLogSegNo;
XLByteToPrevSeg(EndOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLogFileName(origfname, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(origfname))
{
char origpath[MAXPGPATH];
char partialfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
char partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
XLogFilePath(origpath, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
/*
* Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
* file.
*/
XLogArchiveCleanup(partialfname);
durable_rename(origpath, partialpath, ERROR);
XLogArchiveNotify(partialfname);
}
}
}
/*
* Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
*/
PreallocXlogFiles(EndOfLog);
/*
* Okay, we're officially UP.
*/
InRecovery = false;
/* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = EndOfLog;
/* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ShmemVariableCache->latestCompletedXid = ShmemVariableCache->nextXid;
FullTransactionIdRetreat(&ShmemVariableCache->latestCompletedXid);
LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock);
/*
* Start up the commit log and subtrans, if not already done for hot
* standby. (commit timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
*/
if (standbyState == STANDBY_DISABLED)
{
StartupCLOG();
StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
}
/*
* Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
*/
TrimCLOG();
TrimMultiXact();
/* Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions */
RecoverPreparedTransactions();
/*
* Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after
* RecoverPreparedTransactions(), see notes for lock_twophase_recover()
*/
if (standbyState != STANDBY_DISABLED)
ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
/* Shut down xlogreader */
if (readFile >= 0)
{
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
}
XLogReaderFree(xlogreader);
/*
* If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
* backends to write WAL.
*/
LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
XLogReportParameters();
/*
* Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
* commit timestamp.
*/
CompleteCommitTsInitialization();
/*
* All done with end-of-recovery actions.
*
* Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
* consequence. The boolean flag allowing backends to write WAL is
* updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends to look
* at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory. There
* is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and the
* control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
* state while looking at the on-disk control file.
*
* Also, although the boolean flag to allow WAL is probably atomic in
* itself, we use the info_lck here to ensure that there are no race
* conditions concerning visibility of other recent updates to shared
* memory.
*/
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->state = DB_IN_PRODUCTION;
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_DONE;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/*
* If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
* sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
*/
WalSndWakeup();
/*
* If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This
* isn't required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far
* back, and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer
* than is appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
*/
if (promoted)
RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE);
}
/*
* Checks if recovery has reached a consistent state. When consistency is
* reached and we have a valid starting standby snapshot, tell postmaster
* that it can start accepting read-only connections.
*/
static void
CheckRecoveryConsistency(void)
{
XLogRecPtr lastReplayedEndRecPtr;
/*
* During crash recovery, we don't reach a consistent state until we've
* replayed all the WAL.
*/
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint))
return;
Assert(InArchiveRecovery);
/*
* assume that we are called in the startup process, and hence don't need
* a lock to read lastReplayedEndRecPtr
*/
lastReplayedEndRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr;
/*
* Have we reached the point where our base backup was completed?
*/
if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint) &&
ControlFile->backupEndPoint <= lastReplayedEndRecPtr)
{
/*
* We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control.
* The data on disk is now consistent. Reset backupStartPoint and
* backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to make sure we don't
* allow starting up at an earlier point even if recovery is stopped
* and restarted soon after this.
*/
elog(DEBUG1, "end of backup reached");
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastReplayedEndRecPtr)
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastReplayedEndRecPtr;
ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
ControlFile->backupEndPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false;
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
/*
* Have we passed our safe starting point? Note that minRecoveryPoint is
* known to be incorrectly set if ControlFile->backupEndRequired, until
* the XLOG_BACKUP_END arrives to advise us of the correct
* minRecoveryPoint. All we know prior to that is that we're not
* consistent yet.
*/
if (!reachedConsistency && !ControlFile->backupEndRequired &&
minRecoveryPoint <= lastReplayedEndRecPtr &&
XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint))
{
/*
* Check to see if the XLOG sequence contained any unresolved
* references to uninitialized pages.
*/
XLogCheckInvalidPages();
reachedConsistency = true;
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("consistent recovery state reached at %X/%X",
(uint32) (lastReplayedEndRecPtr >> 32),
(uint32) lastReplayedEndRecPtr)));
}
/*
* Have we got a valid starting snapshot that will allow queries to be
* run? If so, we can tell postmaster that the database is consistent now,
* enabling connections.
*/
if (standbyState == STANDBY_SNAPSHOT_READY &&
!LocalHotStandbyActive &&
reachedConsistency &&
IsUnderPostmaster)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->SharedHotStandbyActive = true;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LocalHotStandbyActive = true;
SendPostmasterSignal(PMSIGNAL_BEGIN_HOT_STANDBY);
}
}
/*
* Is the system still in recovery?
*
* Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
* shared memory.
*
* As a side-effect, we initialize the local TimeLineID and RedoRecPtr
* variables the first time we see that recovery is finished.
*/
bool
RecoveryInProgress(void)
{
/*
* We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
* can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
* shared variable has once been seen false.
*/
if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress)
return false;
else
{
/*
* use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
* shared variable.
*/
volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
/*
* Initialize TimeLineID and RedoRecPtr when we discover that recovery
* is finished. InitPostgres() relies upon this behaviour to ensure
* that InitXLOGAccess() is called at backend startup. (If you change
* this, see also LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed.)
*/
if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress)
{
/*
* If we just exited recovery, make sure we read TimeLineID and
* RedoRecPtr after SharedRecoveryState (for machines with weak
* memory ordering).
*/
pg_memory_barrier();
InitXLOGAccess();
}
/*
* Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
* We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
* can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
*/
return LocalRecoveryInProgress;
}
}
/*
* Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
*
* This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
* file. See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
*/
RecoveryState
GetRecoveryState(void)
{
RecoveryState retval;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return retval;
}
/*
* Is HotStandby active yet? This is only important in special backends
* since normal backends won't ever be able to connect until this returns
* true. Postmaster knows this by way of signal, not via shared memory.
*
* Unlike testing standbyState, this works in any process that's connected to
* shared memory. (And note that standbyState alone doesn't tell the truth
* anyway.)
*/
bool
HotStandbyActive(void)
{
/*
* We check shared state each time only until Hot Standby is active. We
* can't de-activate Hot Standby, so there's no need to keep checking
* after the shared variable has once been seen true.
*/
if (LocalHotStandbyActive)
return true;
else
{
/* spinlock is essential on machines with weak memory ordering! */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LocalHotStandbyActive = XLogCtl->SharedHotStandbyActive;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return LocalHotStandbyActive;
}
}
/*
* Like HotStandbyActive(), but to be used only in WAL replay code,
* where we don't need to ask any other process what the state is.
*/
bool
HotStandbyActiveInReplay(void)
{
Assert(AmStartupProcess() || !IsPostmasterEnvironment);
return LocalHotStandbyActive;
}
/*
* Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
*
* Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
* But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
* within specific processes regardless of the global state.
*/
bool
XLogInsertAllowed(void)
{
/*
* If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
* return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
* done.
*/
if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
/*
* Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
*/
if (RecoveryInProgress())
return false;
/*
* On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
* no need to keep checking.
*/
LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
return true;
}
/*
* Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
*
* Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
* and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
*/
static void
LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
{
Assert(LocalXLogInsertAllowed == -1);
LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
/* Initialize as RecoveryInProgress() would do when switching state */
InitXLOGAccess();
}
/*
* Subroutine to try to fetch and validate a prior checkpoint record.
*
* whichChkpt identifies the checkpoint (merely for reporting purposes).
* 1 for "primary", 0 for "other" (backup_label)
*/
static XLogRecord *
ReadCheckpointRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, XLogRecPtr RecPtr,
int whichChkpt, bool report)
{
XLogRecord *record;
uint8 info;
if (!XRecOffIsValid(RecPtr))
{
if (!report)
return NULL;
switch (whichChkpt)
{
case 1:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid primary checkpoint link in control file")));
break;
default:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid checkpoint link in backup_label file")));
break;
}
return NULL;
}
XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, RecPtr);
record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, true);
if (record == NULL)
{
if (!report)
return NULL;
switch (whichChkpt)
{
case 1:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid primary checkpoint record")));
break;
default:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid checkpoint record")));
break;
}
return NULL;
}
if (record->xl_rmid != RM_XLOG_ID)
{
switch (whichChkpt)
{
case 1:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid resource manager ID in primary checkpoint record")));
break;
default:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid resource manager ID in checkpoint record")));
break;
}
return NULL;
}
info = record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
if (info != XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN &&
info != XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
{
switch (whichChkpt)
{
case 1:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid xl_info in primary checkpoint record")));
break;
default:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid xl_info in checkpoint record")));
break;
}
return NULL;
}
if (record->xl_tot_len != SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(CheckPoint))
{
switch (whichChkpt)
{
case 1:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid length of primary checkpoint record")));
break;
default:
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("invalid length of checkpoint record")));
break;
}
return NULL;
}
return record;
}
/*
* This must be called in a backend process before creating WAL records
* (except in a standalone backend, which does StartupXLOG instead). We need
* to initialize the local copies of ThisTimeLineID and RedoRecPtr.
*
* Note: before Postgres 8.0, we went to some effort to keep the postmaster
* process's copies of ThisTimeLineID and RedoRecPtr valid too. This was
* unnecessary however, since the postmaster itself never touches XLOG anyway.
*/
void
InitXLOGAccess(void)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
/* ThisTimeLineID doesn't change so we need no lock to copy it */
ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->ThisTimeLineID;
Assert(ThisTimeLineID != 0 || IsBootstrapProcessingMode());
/* set wal_segment_size */
wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size;
/* Use GetRedoRecPtr to copy the RedoRecPtr safely */
(void) GetRedoRecPtr();
/* Also update our copy of doPageWrites. */
doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->forcePageWrites);
/* Also initialize the working areas for constructing WAL records */
InitXLogInsert();
}
/*
* Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
*
* As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetRedoRecPtr(void)
{
XLogRecPtr ptr;
/*
* The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
* grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
* Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
* the lock.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
RedoRecPtr = ptr;
return RedoRecPtr;
}
/*
* Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
* full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
*
* The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
* possibly out-of-date. XLogInsertRecord will re-check them against
* up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
*/
void
GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
{
*RedoRecPtr_p = RedoRecPtr;
*doPageWrites_p = doPageWrites;
}
/*
* GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
*
* NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
* xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
* For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
* approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetInsertRecPtr(void)
{
XLogRecPtr recptr;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
recptr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return recptr;
}
/*
* GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
* position known to be fsync'd to disk.
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetFlushRecPtr(void)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return LogwrtResult.Flush;
}
/*
* GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
* inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
* important.
*
* The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
* WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
{
XLogRecPtr res = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
int i;
for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
{
XLogRecPtr last_important;
/*
* Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
* possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
* support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
*/
LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
last_important = WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt;
LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
if (res < last_important)
res = last_important;
}
return res;
}
/*
* Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
*/
pg_time_t
GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
{
pg_time_t result;
/* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_SHARED);
result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
*lastSwitchLSN = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN;
LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
return result;
}
/*
* This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
*/
void
ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
{
/*
* We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
* be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
*/
Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
/* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
(errmsg("shutting down")));
/*
* Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
*/
WalSndInitStopping();
/*
* Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands
* from writing new WAL.
*/
WalSndWaitStopping();
if (RecoveryInProgress())
CreateRestartPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE);
else
{
/*
* If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
* remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
* process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
* record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
*/
if (XLogArchivingActive() && XLogArchiveCommandSet())
RequestXLogSwitch(false);
CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE);
}
}
/*
* Log start of a checkpoint.
*/
static void
LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
{
elog(LOG, "%s starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE) ? " immediate" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
(flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL) ? " flush-all" : "");
}
/*
* Log end of a checkpoint.
*/
static void
LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint)
{
long write_secs,
sync_secs,
total_secs,
longest_secs,
average_secs;
int write_usecs,
sync_usecs,
total_usecs,
longest_usecs,
average_usecs;
uint64 average_sync_time;
CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
TimestampDifference(CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t,
&write_secs, &write_usecs);
TimestampDifference(CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t,
&sync_secs, &sync_usecs);
/* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
BgWriterStats.m_checkpoint_write_time +=
write_secs * 1000 + write_usecs / 1000;
BgWriterStats.m_checkpoint_sync_time +=
sync_secs * 1000 + sync_usecs / 1000;
/*
* All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only
* continue if a log message is to be written.
*/
if (!log_checkpoints)
return;
TimestampDifference(CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t,
&total_secs, &total_usecs);
/*
* Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
* Convert to the second plus microsecond form that TimestampDifference
* returns for homogeneous printing.
*/
longest_secs = (long) (CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync / 1000000);
longest_usecs = CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync -
(uint64) longest_secs * 1000000;
average_sync_time = 0;
if (CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels > 0)
average_sync_time = CheckpointStats.ckpt_agg_sync_time /
CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels;
average_secs = (long) (average_sync_time / 1000000);
average_usecs = average_sync_time - (uint64) average_secs * 1000000;
elog(LOG, "%s complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%); "
"%d WAL file(s) added, %d removed, %d recycled; "
"write=%ld.%03d s, sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; "
"sync files=%d, longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; "
"distance=%d kB, estimate=%d kB",
restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint",
CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
(double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
write_secs, write_usecs / 1000,
sync_secs, sync_usecs / 1000,
total_secs, total_usecs / 1000,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
longest_secs, longest_usecs / 1000,
average_secs, average_usecs / 1000,
(int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
(int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0));
}
/*
* Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
*
* The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
* preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
*/
static void
UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
{
/*
* To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
* moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
* cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
* periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
* moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
* used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
* more.
*
* When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
* CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
*
* Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
* Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
* starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
* automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
* not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
* in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
* never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
* preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
* checkpoint_timeout is set to.
*/
PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
CheckPointDistanceEstimate = nbytes;
else
CheckPointDistanceEstimate =
(0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
}
/*
* Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
*
* flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
* CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
* CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
* CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE: finish the checkpoint ASAP,
* ignoring checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
* CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
* since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
* CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
* CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
*
* Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
* In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
* attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
*
* If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. This is a very special
* kind of operation and WAL record because the checkpoint action occurs over
* a period of time yet logically occurs at just a single LSN. The logical
* position of the WAL record (redo ptr) is the same or earlier than the
* physical position. When we replay WAL we locate the checkpoint via its
* physical position then read the redo ptr and actually start replay at the
* earlier logical position. Note that we don't write *anything* to WAL at
* the logical position, so that location could be any other kind of WAL record.
* All of this mechanism allows us to continue working while we checkpoint.
* As a result, timing of actions is critical here and be careful to note that
* this function will likely take minutes to execute on a busy system.
*/
void
CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
{
bool shutdown;
CheckPoint checkPoint;
XLogRecPtr recptr;
XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
uint32 freespace;
XLogRecPtr PriorRedoPtr;
XLogRecPtr curInsert;
XLogRecPtr last_important_lsn;
VirtualTransactionId *vxids;
int nvxids;
/*
* An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
* issued at a different time.
*/
if (flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY))
shutdown = true;
else
shutdown = false;
/* sanity check */
if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
/*
* Initialize InitXLogInsert working areas before entering the critical
* section. Normally, this is done by the first call to
* RecoveryInProgress() or LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(), but when creating
* an end-of-recovery checkpoint, the LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed call is
* done below in a critical section, and InitXLogInsert cannot be called
* in a critical section.
*/
InitXLogInsert();
/*
* Acquire CheckpointLock to ensure only one checkpoint happens at a time.
* (This is just pro forma, since in the present system structure there is
* only one process that is allowed to issue checkpoints at any given
* time.)
*/
LWLockAcquire(CheckpointLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
/*
* Prepare to accumulate statistics.
*
* Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
* checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
* log_checkpoints is currently off.
*/
MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
/*
* Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
*/
START_CRIT_SECTION();
if (shutdown)
{
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNING;
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
/*
* Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen before we determine
* the REDO pointer. Note that smgr must not do anything that'd have to
* be undone if we decide no checkpoint is needed.
*/
SyncPreCheckpoint();
/* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
/*
* For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
* pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
* starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
*/
if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId();
else
checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
/*
* Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
* GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
*/
last_important_lsn = GetLastImportantRecPtr();
/*
* We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state to
* determine the checkpoint REDO pointer.
*/
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
curInsert = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(Insert->CurrBytePos);
/*
* If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
* WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to
* avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
*/
if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
{
if (last_important_lsn == ControlFile->checkPoint)
{
WALInsertLockRelease();
LWLockRelease(CheckpointLock);
END_CRIT_SECTION();
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
return;
}
}
/*
* An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
* write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
* enable XLogInsertAllowed. (This also ensures ThisTimeLineID is
* initialized, which we need here and in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.)
*/
if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
else
checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
/*
* Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
*
* NB: this is NOT necessarily where the checkpoint record itself will be,
* since other backends may insert more XLOG records while we're off doing
* the buffer flush work. Those XLOG records are logically after the
* checkpoint, even though physically before it. Got that?
*/
freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
if (freespace == 0)
{
if (XLogSegmentOffset(curInsert, wal_segment_size) == 0)
curInsert += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
else
curInsert += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
}
checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
/*
* Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls; this
* must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
*
* Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be left
* pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay; the only
* consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers that it
* didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing RedoRecPtr because
* XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping buffers must assume that
* their buffer changes are not included in the checkpoint.
*/
RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
/*
* Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
* proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
*/
WALInsertLockRelease();
/* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not
* to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
*/
if (log_checkpoints)
LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
/*
* Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
*
* We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
* for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
* during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
* there.
*/
LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
checkPoint.nextXid = ShmemVariableCache->nextXid;
checkPoint.oldestXid = ShmemVariableCache->oldestXid;
checkPoint.oldestXidDB = ShmemVariableCache->oldestXidDB;
LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
LWLockAcquire(CommitTsLock, LW_SHARED);
checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = ShmemVariableCache->oldestCommitTsXid;
checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = ShmemVariableCache->newestCommitTsXid;
LWLockRelease(CommitTsLock);
LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
checkPoint.nextOid = ShmemVariableCache->nextOid;
if (!shutdown)
checkPoint.nextOid += ShmemVariableCache->oidCount;
LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(shutdown,
&checkPoint.nextMulti,
&checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
&checkPoint.oldestMulti,
&checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
/*
* Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
* and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
*
* This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to
* complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
* panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
*/
END_CRIT_SECTION();
/*
* In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
* side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
* checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
* performing those groups of actions.
*
* One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
* that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted
* its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
* restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
* that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So
* we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
* See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
*
* Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
* fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
* to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
* checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
* necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
* does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
* protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
* minimizing lock contention.)
*
* A transaction that has not yet set delayChkpt when we look cannot be at
* risk, since he's not inserted his commit record yet; and one that's
* already cleared it is not at risk either, since he's done fixing clog
* and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss any
* xacts we need to wait for.
*/
vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids);
if (nvxids > 0)
{
do
{
pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
} while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids));
}
pfree(vxids);
CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
/*
* Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
* allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
* archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
*
* If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
* recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
*/
if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
LogStandbySnapshot();
START_CRIT_SECTION();
/*
* Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
*/
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) (&checkPoint), sizeof(checkPoint));
recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID,
shutdown ? XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN :
XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE);
XLogFlush(recptr);
/*
* We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
* overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows
* sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
* to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
* recovery.
*/
if (shutdown)
{
if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; /* return to "check" state */
else
LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
}
/*
* We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
* = end of actual checkpoint record.
*/
if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
/*
* Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
* UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
*/
PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
/*
* Update the control file.
*/
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (shutdown)
ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
ControlFile->checkPoint = ProcLastRecPtr;
ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
/* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
/*
* Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
* unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
* for debugging purposes.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck);
ControlFile->unloggedLSN = XLogCtl->unloggedLSN;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck);
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
* have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
*/
END_CRIT_SECTION();
/*
* Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
*/
SyncPostCheckpoint();
/*
* Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
* exists.
*/
if (PriorRedoPtr != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
/*
* Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
* prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
*/
XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(_logSegNo);
_logSegNo--;
RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, recptr);
/*
* Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
* segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
*/
if (!shutdown)
PreallocXlogFiles(recptr);
/*
* Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
* the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
* attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
* in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
* StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
*/
if (!RecoveryInProgress())
TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
/* Real work is done, but log and update stats before releasing lock. */
LogCheckpointEnd(false);
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_DONE(CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
NBuffers,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled);
LWLockRelease(CheckpointLock);
}
/*
* Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
* We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
* do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete. So be
* careful to avoid taking the CheckpointLock anywhere here.
*
* CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
* the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
*/
static void
CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
{
xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
XLogRecPtr recptr;
/* sanity check */
if (!RecoveryInProgress())
elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID;
xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
WALInsertLockRelease();
LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
START_CRIT_SECTION();
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY);
XLogFlush(recptr);
/*
* Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
* changes to this point.
*/
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = recptr;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
END_CRIT_SECTION();
LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; /* return to "check" state */
}
/*
* Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
*
* This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
* recovery restartpoints.
*/
static void
CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
{
CheckPointRelationMap();
CheckPointReplicationSlots();
CheckPointSnapBuild();
CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap();
CheckPointReplicationOrigin();
/* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
CheckPointCLOG();
CheckPointCommitTs();
CheckPointSUBTRANS();
CheckPointMultiXact();
CheckPointPredicate();
CheckPointBuffers(flags);
/* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_SYNC_START();
CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
ProcessSyncRequests();
CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_DONE();
/* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
CheckPointTwoPhase(checkPointRedo);
}
/*
* Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
*
* This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
* It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
* not. If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
* CreateRestartPoint can consult it. (Note that the latter function is
* executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
* startup process.)
*/
static void
RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint)
{
/*
* Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
* references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
* restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
* cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
* later.
*/
if (XLogHaveInvalidPages())
{
elog(trace_recovery(DEBUG2),
"could not record restart point at %X/%X because there "
"are unresolved references to invalid pages",
(uint32) (checkPoint->redo >> 32),
(uint32) checkPoint->redo);
return;
}
/*
* Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
* work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr = ReadRecPtr;
XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr = EndRecPtr;
XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* Establish a restartpoint if possible.
*
* This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
* to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
* replaying the entire recovery log.
*
* Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
* a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
* restartpoint.
*/
bool
CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
{
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
XLogRecPtr PriorRedoPtr;
XLogRecPtr receivePtr;
XLogRecPtr replayPtr;
TimeLineID replayTLI;
XLogRecPtr endptr;
XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
TimestampTz xtime;
/*
* Acquire CheckpointLock to ensure only one restartpoint or checkpoint
* happens at a time.
*/
LWLockAcquire(CheckpointLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
/* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
* mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
*/
if (!RecoveryInProgress())
{
ereport(DEBUG2,
(errmsg("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
LWLockRelease(CheckpointLock);
return false;
}
/*
* If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
* restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
* minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
* point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
* necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
* the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
* before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
* immediate shutdown, though.
*
* We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
* restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
* side-effect.
*/
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
{
ereport(DEBUG2,
(errmsg("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%X",
(uint32) (lastCheckPoint.redo >> 32),
(uint32) lastCheckPoint.redo)));
UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
{
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
LWLockRelease(CheckpointLock);
return false;
}
/*
* Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
* the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
* restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
*
* Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
* during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
* happening.
*/
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
WALInsertLockRelease();
/* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* Prepare to accumulate statistics.
*
* Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
* checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
* log_checkpoints is currently off.
*/
MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
if (log_checkpoints)
LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
/*
* Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
* UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
*/
PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
/*
* Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows
* DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY state and an older checkpoint, else do nothing;
* this is a quick hack to make sure nothing really bad happens if somehow
* we get here after the end-of-recovery checkpoint.
*/
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (ControlFile->state == DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY &&
ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
{
ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
/*
* Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record. Normally,
* this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
* but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do
* this because a non-exclusive base backup uses minRecoveryPoint to
* determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and the
* file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be included,
* at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of recovery there's
* no value in having the minimum recovery point any earlier than this
* anyway, because redo will begin just after the checkpoint record.
*/
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
{
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = lastCheckPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
/* update local copy */
minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
}
if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
UpdateControlFile();
}
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/*
* Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
* prior checkpoint exists.
*/
if (PriorRedoPtr != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
/*
* Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
* prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
*/
XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
/*
* Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
* whichever is later.
*/
receivePtr = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(NULL, NULL);
replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(_logSegNo);
_logSegNo--;
/*
* Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
* since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
* at end of recovery (RecoveryInProgress() sets ThisTimeLineID in that
* case). If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're currently
* replaying.
*
* There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
* current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
* this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
* and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
* with that.
*/
if (RecoveryInProgress())
ThisTimeLineID = replayTLI;
RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr);
/*
* Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
* segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
*/
PreallocXlogFiles(endptr);
/*
* ThisTimeLineID is normally not set when we're still in recovery.
* However, recycling/preallocating segments above needed ThisTimeLineID
* to determine which timeline to install the segments on. Reset it now,
* to restore the normal state of affairs for debugging purposes.
*/
if (RecoveryInProgress())
ThisTimeLineID = 0;
/*
* Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
* the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
* attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
* in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
* this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
*/
if (EnableHotStandby)
TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
/* Real work is done, but log and update before releasing lock. */
LogCheckpointEnd(true);
xtime = GetLatestXTime();
ereport((log_checkpoints ? LOG : DEBUG2),
(errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%X",
(uint32) (lastCheckPoint.redo >> 32), (uint32) lastCheckPoint.redo),
xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0));
LWLockRelease(CheckpointLock);
/*
* Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
*/
if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0)
ExecuteRecoveryCommand(archiveCleanupCommand,
"archive_cleanup_command",
false);
return true;
}
/*
* Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
* (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
*
* Returns one of the following enum values:
*
* * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
* max_wal_size.
*
* * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
* segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
* than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
*
* * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
* remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
* above.
*
* * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
* a slot with this LSN cannot continue after a restart.
*
* * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
*/
WALAvailability
GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
{
XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */
XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */
XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */
XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */
XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */
uint64 keepSegs;
/*
* slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
*/
if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(targetLSN))
return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
/*
* Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
* considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize
* oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
*/
currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
XLByteToSeg(currpos, oldestSlotSeg, wal_segment_size);
KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
/*
* Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
* the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
* wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
*/
oldestSeg = XLogGetLastRemovedSegno() + 1;
/* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
XLByteToSeg(currpos, currSeg, wal_segment_size);
keepSegs = ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) + 1;
if (currSeg > keepSegs)
oldestSegMaxWalSize = currSeg - keepSegs;
else
oldestSegMaxWalSize = 1;
/* the segment we care about */
XLByteToSeg(targetLSN, targetSeg, wal_segment_size);
/*
* No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
* targetSeg is known to be lost.
*/
if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
{
/* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
if (targetSeg >= oldestSegMaxWalSize)
return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
/* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
}
/* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
/* Definitely lost */
return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
}
/*
* Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
* either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
*
* This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
* location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
* requirement of replication slots. For the latter criterion we do consider
* the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
* from recptr.
*/
static void
KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
{
XLogSegNo currSegNo;
XLogSegNo segno;
XLogRecPtr keep;
XLByteToSeg(recptr, currSegNo, wal_segment_size);
segno = currSegNo;
/*
* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots first, adjusting for
* max_slot_wal_keep_size.
*/
keep = XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN();
if (keep != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
{
XLByteToSeg(keep, segno, wal_segment_size);
/* Cap by max_slot_wal_keep_size ... */
if (max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb >= 0)
{
uint64 slot_keep_segs;
slot_keep_segs =
ConvertToXSegs(max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
}
}
/* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
{
uint64 keep_segs;
keep_segs = ConvertToXSegs(wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
{
/* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
segno = 1;
else
segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
}
}
/* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
if (segno < *logSegNo)
*logSegNo = segno;
}
/*
* Write a NEXTOID log record
*/
void
XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
{
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) (&nextOid), sizeof(Oid));
(void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTOID);
/*
* We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
* just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
* update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
* record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
* records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
* does.
*
* Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
* database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
* are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
* change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact
* of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
* might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
* with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we
* always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
* problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
*/
}
/*
* Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
*
* Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
* All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
*
* The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
* or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
* write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
*/
XLogRecPtr
RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
{
XLogRecPtr RecPtr;
/* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
XLogBeginInsert();
if (mark_unimportant)
XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT);
RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_SWITCH);
return RecPtr;
}
/*
* Write a RESTORE POINT record
*/
XLogRecPtr
XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
{
XLogRecPtr RecPtr;
xl_restore_point xlrec;
xlrec.rp_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_restore_point));
RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT);
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%X",
rpName, (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr)));
return RecPtr;
}
/*
* Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
* have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
*/
static void
XLogReportParameters(void)
{
if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level ||
wal_log_hints != ControlFile->wal_log_hints ||
MaxConnections != ControlFile->MaxConnections ||
max_worker_processes != ControlFile->max_worker_processes ||
max_wal_senders != ControlFile->max_wal_senders ||
max_prepared_xacts != ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts ||
max_locks_per_xact != ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact ||
track_commit_timestamp != ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
{
/*
* The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
* if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
* with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
* values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
* to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
*/
if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level || XLogIsNeeded())
{
xl_parameter_change xlrec;
XLogRecPtr recptr;
xlrec.MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE);
XLogFlush(recptr);
}
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
}
/*
* Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
* XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
*
* Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
* concurrently that could update it.
*/
void
UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
bool recoveryInProgress;
/*
* Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
*
* It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
* because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
* can update it.
*/
if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
return;
/*
* Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
* initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
* assertion failure.
*/
recoveryInProgress = RecoveryInProgress();
START_CRIT_SECTION();
/*
* It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
* required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
* to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
* setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
* flag.
*/
if (fullPageWrites)
{
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
WALInsertLockRelease();
}
/*
* Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
* full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
*/
if (XLogStandbyInfoActive() && !recoveryInProgress)
{
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) (&fullPageWrites), sizeof(bool));
XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE);
}
if (!fullPageWrites)
{
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
WALInsertLockRelease();
}
END_CRIT_SECTION();
}
/*
* Check that it's OK to switch to new timeline during recovery.
*
* 'lsn' is the address of the shutdown checkpoint record we're about to
* replay. (Currently, timeline can only change at a shutdown checkpoint).
*/
static void
checkTimeLineSwitch(XLogRecPtr lsn, TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID prevTLI)
{
/* Check that the record agrees on what the current (old) timeline is */
if (prevTLI != ThisTimeLineID)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("unexpected previous timeline ID %u (current timeline ID %u) in checkpoint record",
prevTLI, ThisTimeLineID)));
/*
* The new timeline better be in the list of timelines we expect to see,
* according to the timeline history. It should also not decrease.
*/
if (newTLI < ThisTimeLineID || !tliInHistory(newTLI, expectedTLEs))
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (after %u) in checkpoint record",
newTLI, ThisTimeLineID)));
/*
* If we have not yet reached min recovery point, and we're about to
* switch to a timeline greater than the timeline of the min recovery
* point: trouble. After switching to the new timeline, we could not
* possibly visit the min recovery point on the correct timeline anymore.
* This can happen if there is a newer timeline in the archive that
* branched before the timeline the min recovery point is on, and you
* attempt to do PITR to the new timeline.
*/
if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint) &&
lsn < minRecoveryPoint &&
newTLI > minRecoveryPointTLI)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u in checkpoint record, before reaching minimum recovery point %X/%X on timeline %u",
newTLI,
(uint32) (minRecoveryPoint >> 32),
(uint32) minRecoveryPoint,
minRecoveryPointTLI)));
/* Looks good */
}
/*
* XLOG resource manager's routines
*
* Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
* not all record types are related to control file updates.
*/
void
xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
{
uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
/* in XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI records */
Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
!XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
{
Oid nextOid;
/*
* We used to try to take the maximum of ShmemVariableCache->nextOid
* and the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
* around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
* anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take
* OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
*/
memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = nextOid;
ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0;
LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
}
else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
{
CheckPoint checkPoint;
memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
/* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0;
LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
/*
* No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
* redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
*/
SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
/*
* If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
* record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
* never arrive.
*/
if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) &&
XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint))
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
/*
* If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
* on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
* record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
* for prepared transactions.
*/
if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED)
{
TransactionId *xids;
int nxids;
TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
RunningTransactionsData running;
oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
/*
* Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
* down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
* never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
* with their parent prepared transactions.
*/
running.xcnt = nxids;
running.subxcnt = 0;
running.subxid_overflow = false;
running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
running.xids = xids;
ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
}
/* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/*
* We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
* record.
*/
if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != ThisTimeLineID)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in checkpoint record",
checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, ThisTimeLineID)));
RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint);
}
else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
{
CheckPoint checkPoint;
memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
/* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (FullTransactionIdPrecedes(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid,
checkPoint.nextXid))
ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
/*
* We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
* to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid
* counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
* compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the
* maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
* there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
* counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case,
* users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
* duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
*/
/* Handle multixact */
MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
/*
* NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
* generated by an older primary.
*/
MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
if (TransactionIdPrecedes(ShmemVariableCache->oldestXid,
checkPoint.oldestXid))
SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid,
checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
/* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
/* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != ThisTimeLineID)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in checkpoint record",
checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, ThisTimeLineID)));
RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint);
}
else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
{
xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
/*
* For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
* but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
* outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
*/
/*
* We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
* record.
*/
if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != ThisTimeLineID)
ereport(PANIC,
(errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in checkpoint record",
xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, ThisTimeLineID)));
}
else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
{
/* nothing to do here */
}
else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
{
/* nothing to do here */
}
else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
{
/* nothing to do here */
}
else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
{
/*
* Full-page image (FPI) records contain nothing else but a backup
* block (or multiple backup blocks). Every block reference must
* include a full-page image - otherwise there would be no point in
* this record.
*
* No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
* resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
* separate WAL record type and redo routine.
*
* XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
* WAL- logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
* when checksums are enabled. There is no difference in handling
* XLOG_FPI and XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records, they use a different info
* code just to distinguish them for statistics purposes.
*/
for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= record->max_block_id; block_id++)
{
Buffer buffer;
if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
}
}
else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
{
XLogRecPtr startpoint;
memcpy(&startpoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(startpoint));
if (ControlFile->backupStartPoint == startpoint)
{
/*
* We have reached the end of base backup, the point where
* pg_stop_backup() was done. The data on disk is now consistent.
* Reset backupStartPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to make
* sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
* recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
*/
elog(DEBUG1, "end of backup reached");
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lsn)
{
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
}
ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false;
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
}
else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
{
xl_parameter_change xlrec;
/* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
/*
* Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
* recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
* This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
* you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
* local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
* happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
*/
if (InArchiveRecovery)
{
minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
}
if (minRecoveryPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr && minRecoveryPoint < lsn)
{
ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn;
ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID;
}
CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp);
ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
UpdateControlFile();
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
/* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
CheckRequiredParameterValues();
}
else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
{
bool fpw;
memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
/*
* Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
* do_pg_start_backup() and do_pg_stop_backup() can check whether
* full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
*/
if (!fpw)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr < ReadRecPtr)
XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr = ReadRecPtr;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/* Keep track of full_page_writes */
lastFullPageWrites = fpw;
}
}
#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
static void
xlog_outrec(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)
{
int block_id;
appendStringInfo(buf, "prev %X/%X; xid %u",
(uint32) (XLogRecGetPrev(record) >> 32),
(uint32) XLogRecGetPrev(record),
XLogRecGetXid(record));
appendStringInfo(buf, "; len %u",
XLogRecGetDataLen(record));
/* decode block references */
for (block_id = 0; block_id <= record->max_block_id; block_id++)
{
RelFileNode rnode;
ForkNumber forknum;
BlockNumber blk;
if (!XLogRecHasBlockRef(record, block_id))
continue;
XLogRecGetBlockTag(record, block_id, &rnode, &forknum, &blk);
if (forknum != MAIN_FORKNUM)
appendStringInfo(buf, "; blkref #%u: rel %u/%u/%u, fork %u, blk %u",
block_id,
rnode.spcNode, rnode.dbNode, rnode.relNode,
forknum,
blk);
else
appendStringInfo(buf, "; blkref #%u: rel %u/%u/%u, blk %u",
block_id,
rnode.spcNode, rnode.dbNode, rnode.relNode,
blk);
if (XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
appendStringInfoString(buf, " FPW");
}
}
#endif /* WAL_DEBUG */
/*
* Returns a string describing an XLogRecord, consisting of its identity
* optionally followed by a colon, a space, and a further description.
*/
static void
xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)
{
RmgrId rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record);
uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record);
const char *id;
appendStringInfoString(buf, RmgrTable[rmid].rm_name);
appendStringInfoChar(buf, '/');
id = RmgrTable[rmid].rm_identify(info);
if (id == NULL)
appendStringInfo(buf, "UNKNOWN (%X): ", info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK);
else
appendStringInfo(buf, "%s: ", id);
RmgrTable[rmid].rm_desc(buf, record);
}
/*
* Return the (possible) sync flag used for opening a file, depending on the
* value of the GUC wal_sync_method.
*/
static int
get_sync_bit(int method)
{
int o_direct_flag = 0;
/* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
if (!enableFsync)
return 0;
/*
* Optimize writes by bypassing kernel cache with O_DIRECT when using
* O_SYNC/O_FSYNC and O_DSYNC. But only if archiving and streaming are
* disabled, otherwise the archive command or walsender process will read
* the WAL soon after writing it, which is guaranteed to cause a physical
* read if we bypassed the kernel cache. We also skip the
* posix_fadvise(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED) call in XLogFileClose() for the same
* reason.
*
* Never use O_DIRECT in walreceiver process for similar reasons; the WAL
* written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
* after its written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
* don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
*/
if (!XLogIsNeeded() && !AmWalReceiverProcess())
o_direct_flag = PG_O_DIRECT;
switch (method)
{
/*
* enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
* not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are
* not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
* be seen here.
*/
case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
case SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
return 0;
#ifdef OPEN_SYNC_FLAG
case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
return OPEN_SYNC_FLAG | o_direct_flag;
#endif
#ifdef OPEN_DATASYNC_FLAG
case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
return OPEN_DATASYNC_FLAG | o_direct_flag;
#endif
default:
/* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
elog(ERROR, "unrecognized wal_sync_method: %d", method);
return 0; /* silence warning */
}
}
/*
* GUC support
*/
void
assign_xlog_sync_method(int new_sync_method, void *extra)
{
if (sync_method != new_sync_method)
{
/*
* To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
* currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is
* changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
* bit) at next use.
*/
if (openLogFile >= 0)
{
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD_ASSIGN);
if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
int save_errno;
save_errno = errno;
XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, openLogSegNo,
wal_segment_size);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (get_sync_bit(sync_method) != get_sync_bit(new_sync_method))
XLogFileClose();
}
}
}
/*
* Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
*
* 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
* 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
*/
void
issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno)
{
char *msg = NULL;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC);
switch (sync_method)
{
case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
break;
#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
break;
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_FDATASYNC
case SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
break;
#endif
case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
/* write synced it already */
break;
default:
elog(PANIC, "unrecognized wal_sync_method: %d", sync_method);
break;
}
/* PANIC if failed to fsync */
if (msg)
{
char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
int save_errno = errno;
XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, segno,
wal_segment_size);
errno = save_errno;
ereport(PANIC,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
}
/*
* do_pg_start_backup
*
* Utility function called at the start of an online backup. It creates the
* necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the backup label file.
*
* There are two kind of backups: exclusive and non-exclusive. An exclusive
* backup is started with pg_start_backup(), and there can be only one active
* at a time. The backup and tablespace map files of an exclusive backup are
* written to $PGDATA/backup_label and $PGDATA/tablespace_map, and they are
* removed by pg_stop_backup().
*
* A non-exclusive backup is used for the streaming base backups (see
* src/backend/replication/basebackup.c). The difference to exclusive backups
* is that the backup label and tablespace map files are not written to disk.
* Instead, their would-be contents are returned in *labelfile and *tblspcmapfile,
* and the caller is responsible for including them in the backup archive as
* 'backup_label' and 'tablespace_map'. There can be many non-exclusive backups
* active at the same time, and they don't conflict with an exclusive backup
* either.
*
* tablespaces is required only when this function is called while
* the streaming base backup requested by pg_basebackup is running.
* NULL should be specified otherwise.
*
* tblspcmapfile is required mainly for tar format in windows as native windows
* utilities are not able to create symlinks while extracting files from tar.
* However for consistency, the same is used for all platforms.
*
* needtblspcmapfile is true for the cases (exclusive backup and for
* non-exclusive backup only when tar format is used for taking backup)
* when backup needs to generate tablespace_map file, it is used to
* embed escape character before newline character in tablespace path.
*
* Returns the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
* backup, and the corresponding timeline ID in *starttli_p.
*
* Every successfully started non-exclusive backup must be stopped by calling
* do_pg_stop_backup() or do_pg_abort_backup().
*
* It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
* permissions of the calling user!
*/
XLogRecPtr
do_pg_start_backup(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, TimeLineID *starttli_p,
StringInfo labelfile, List **tablespaces,
StringInfo tblspcmapfile, bool needtblspcmapfile)
{
bool exclusive = (labelfile == NULL);
bool backup_started_in_recovery = false;
XLogRecPtr checkpointloc;
XLogRecPtr startpoint;
TimeLineID starttli;
pg_time_t stamp_time;
char strfbuf[128];
char xlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
struct stat stat_buf;
FILE *fp;
backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
/*
* Currently only non-exclusive backup can be taken during recovery.
*/
if (backup_started_in_recovery && exclusive)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("recovery is in progress"),
errhint("WAL control functions cannot be executed during recovery.")));
/*
* During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
* level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
*/
if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
errhint("wal_level must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
if (strlen(backupidstr) > MAXPGPATH)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
MAXPGPATH)));
/*
* Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes
* during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
* it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
* written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
* our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first
* write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
* turn on forcePageWrites and then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there
* are no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the
* backup is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once
* the backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore,
* since we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval
* must have been correctly captured by the backup.)
*
* Note that forcePageWrites has no effect during an online backup from
* the standby.
*
* We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
* forcePageWrites, to ensure adequate interlocking against
* XLogInsertRecord().
*/
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
if (exclusive)
{
/*
* At first, mark that we're now starting an exclusive backup, to
* ensure that there are no other sessions currently running
* pg_start_backup() or pg_stop_backup().
*/
if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState != EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE)
{
WALInsertLockRelease();
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("a backup is already in progress"),
errhint("Run pg_stop_backup() and try again.")));
}
XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING;
}
else
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups++;
XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = true;
WALInsertLockRelease();
/* Ensure we release forcePageWrites if fail below */
PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_start_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive));
{
bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
DIR *tblspcdir;
struct dirent *de;
tablespaceinfo *ti;
int datadirpathlen;
/*
* Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
* WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
* old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called
* pg_start_backup() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
* first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
* the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at
* recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
* pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
* archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
*
* This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has
* XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record.
* Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to
* compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that
* occur after this point.
*
* During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
* the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
* recovery case described above.
*/
if (!backup_started_in_recovery)
RequestXLogSwitch(false);
do
{
bool checkpointfpw;
/*
* Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
* page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
* will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
* history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
*
* During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
* the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
* means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
* positions.
*
* Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_start_backup()
* during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
* RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
*
* We use CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE only if requested by user (via
* passing fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile.
*/
RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE | CHECKPOINT_WAIT |
(fast ? CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE : 0));
/*
* Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
* its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
* to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
* pointer.
*/
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
starttli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
checkpointfpw = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.fullPageWrites;
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
if (backup_started_in_recovery)
{
XLogRecPtr recptr;
/*
* Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
* (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
* checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (!checkpointfpw || startpoint <= recptr)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("WAL generated with full_page_writes=off was replayed "
"since last restartpoint"),
errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
"is corrupt and should not be used. "
"Enable full_page_writes and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
"and then try an online backup again.")));
/*
* During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
* record and don't write the backup history file, the
* starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
* that two base backups started at the same time might use
* the same checkpoint as starting locations.
*/
gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
}
/*
* If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
* processes), we need to make sure that they use different
* checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
* WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
* end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
* file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
* for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
* taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
* either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
*/
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < startpoint)
{
XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = startpoint;
gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
}
WALInsertLockRelease();
} while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
XLByteToSeg(startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLogFileName(xlogfilename, starttli, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
/*
* Construct tablespace_map file
*/
if (exclusive)
tblspcmapfile = makeStringInfo();
datadirpathlen = strlen(DataDir);
/* Collect information about all tablespaces */
tblspcdir = AllocateDir("pg_tblspc");
while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, "pg_tblspc")) != NULL)
{
char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + 10];
char linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
char *relpath = NULL;
int rllen;
StringInfoData buflinkpath;
char *s = linkpath;
/* Skip special stuff */
if (strcmp(de->d_name, ".") == 0 || strcmp(de->d_name, "..") == 0)
continue;
snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "pg_tblspc/%s", de->d_name);
#if defined(HAVE_READLINK) || defined(WIN32)
rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
if (rllen < 0)
{
ereport(WARNING,
(errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
fullpath)));
continue;
}
else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
{
ereport(WARNING,
(errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
fullpath)));
continue;
}
linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
/*
* Add the escape character '\\' before newline in a string to
* ensure that we can distinguish between the newline in the
* tablespace path and end of line while reading tablespace_map
* file during archive recovery.
*/
initStringInfo(&buflinkpath);
while (*s)
{
if ((*s == '\n' || *s == '\r') && needtblspcmapfile)
appendStringInfoChar(&buflinkpath, '\\');
appendStringInfoChar(&buflinkpath, *s++);
}
/*
* Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
* when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
* elsewhere.
*/
if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
strncmp(linkpath, DataDir, datadirpathlen) == 0 &&
IS_DIR_SEP(linkpath[datadirpathlen]))
relpath = linkpath + datadirpathlen + 1;
ti = palloc(sizeof(tablespaceinfo));
ti->oid = pstrdup(de->d_name);
ti->path = pstrdup(buflinkpath.data);
ti->rpath = relpath ? pstrdup(relpath) : NULL;
ti->size = -1;
if (tablespaces)
*tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
appendStringInfo(tblspcmapfile, "%s %s\n", ti->oid, ti->path);
pfree(buflinkpath.data);
#else
/*
* If the platform does not have symbolic links, it should not be
* possible to have tablespaces - clearly somebody else created
* them. Warn about it and ignore.
*/
ereport(WARNING,
(errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
errmsg("tablespaces are not supported on this platform")));
#endif
}
FreeDir(tblspcdir);
/*
* Construct backup label file
*/
if (exclusive)
labelfile = makeStringInfo();
/* Use the log timezone here, not the session timezone */
stamp_time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
pg_strftime(strfbuf, sizeof(strfbuf),
"%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
pg_localtime(&stamp_time, log_timezone));
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %s)\n",
(uint32) (startpoint >> 32), (uint32) startpoint, xlogfilename);
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "CHECKPOINT LOCATION: %X/%X\n",
(uint32) (checkpointloc >> 32), (uint32) checkpointloc);
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "BACKUP METHOD: %s\n",
exclusive ? "pg_start_backup" : "streamed");
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "BACKUP FROM: %s\n",
backup_started_in_recovery ? "standby" : "primary");
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "START TIME: %s\n", strfbuf);
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "LABEL: %s\n", backupidstr);
appendStringInfo(labelfile, "START TIMELINE: %u\n", starttli);
/*
* Okay, write the file, or return its contents to caller.
*/
if (exclusive)
{
/*
* Check for existing backup label --- implies a backup is already
* running. (XXX given that we checked exclusiveBackupState
* above, maybe it would be OK to just unlink any such label
* file?)
*/
if (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &stat_buf) != 0)
{
if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
}
else
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("a backup is already in progress"),
errhint("If you're sure there is no backup in progress, remove file \"%s\" and try again.",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
fp = AllocateFile(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, "w");
if (!fp)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
if (fwrite(labelfile->data, labelfile->len, 1, fp) != 1 ||
fflush(fp) != 0 ||
pg_fsync(fileno(fp)) != 0 ||
ferror(fp) ||
FreeFile(fp))
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
/* Allocated locally for exclusive backups, so free separately */
pfree(labelfile->data);
pfree(labelfile);
/* Write backup tablespace_map file. */
if (tblspcmapfile->len > 0)
{
if (stat(TABLESPACE_MAP, &stat_buf) != 0)
{
if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m",
TABLESPACE_MAP)));
}
else
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("a backup is already in progress"),
errhint("If you're sure there is no backup in progress, remove file \"%s\" and try again.",
TABLESPACE_MAP)));
fp = AllocateFile(TABLESPACE_MAP, "w");
if (!fp)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
TABLESPACE_MAP)));
if (fwrite(tblspcmapfile->data, tblspcmapfile->len, 1, fp) != 1 ||
fflush(fp) != 0 ||
pg_fsync(fileno(fp)) != 0 ||
ferror(fp) ||
FreeFile(fp))
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
TABLESPACE_MAP)));
}
/* Allocated locally for exclusive backups, so free separately */
pfree(tblspcmapfile->data);
pfree(tblspcmapfile);
}
}
PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_start_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive));
/*
* Mark that start phase has correctly finished for an exclusive backup.
* Session-level locks are updated as well to reflect that state.
*
* Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating backup
* counters and session-level lock. Otherwise they can be updated
* inconsistently, and which might cause do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
*/
if (exclusive)
{
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS;
/* Set session-level lock */
sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_EXCLUSIVE;
WALInsertLockRelease();
}
else
sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NON_EXCLUSIVE;
/*
* We're done. As a convenience, return the starting WAL location.
*/
if (starttli_p)
*starttli_p = starttli;
return startpoint;
}
/* Error cleanup callback for pg_start_backup */
static void
pg_start_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg)
{
bool exclusive = DatumGetBool(arg);
/* Update backup counters and forcePageWrites on failure */
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
if (exclusive)
{
Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING);
XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE;
}
else
{
Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups > 0);
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups--;
}
if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE &&
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups == 0)
{
XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = false;
}
WALInsertLockRelease();
}
/*
* Error cleanup callback for pg_stop_backup
*/
static void
pg_stop_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg)
{
bool exclusive = DatumGetBool(arg);
/* Update backup status on failure */
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
if (exclusive)
{
Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING);
XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS;
}
WALInsertLockRelease();
}
/*
* Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
*/
SessionBackupState
get_backup_status(void)
{
return sessionBackupState;
}
/*
* do_pg_stop_backup
*
* Utility function called at the end of an online backup. It cleans up the
* backup state and can optionally wait for WAL segments to be archived.
*
* If labelfile is NULL, this stops an exclusive backup. Otherwise this stops
* the non-exclusive backup specified by 'labelfile'.
*
* Returns the last WAL location that must be present to restore from this
* backup, and the corresponding timeline ID in *stoptli_p.
*
* It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
* permissions of the calling user!
*/
XLogRecPtr
do_pg_stop_backup(char *labelfile, bool waitforarchive, TimeLineID *stoptli_p)
{
bool exclusive = (labelfile == NULL);
bool backup_started_in_recovery = false;
XLogRecPtr startpoint;
XLogRecPtr stoppoint;
TimeLineID stoptli;
pg_time_t stamp_time;
char strfbuf[128];
char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
char startxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
char stopxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
char lastxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
char histfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
char backupfrom[20];
XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
FILE *lfp;
FILE *fp;
char ch;
int seconds_before_warning;
int waits = 0;
bool reported_waiting = false;
char *remaining;
char *ptr;
uint32 hi,
lo;
backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
/*
* Currently only non-exclusive backup can be taken during recovery.
*/
if (backup_started_in_recovery && exclusive)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("recovery is in progress"),
errhint("WAL control functions cannot be executed during recovery.")));
/*
* During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
* level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
*/
if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
errhint("wal_level must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
if (exclusive)
{
/*
* At first, mark that we're now stopping an exclusive backup, to
* ensure that there are no other sessions currently running
* pg_start_backup() or pg_stop_backup().
*/
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState != EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS)
{
WALInsertLockRelease();
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("exclusive backup not in progress")));
}
XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING;
WALInsertLockRelease();
/*
* Remove backup_label. In case of failure, the state for an exclusive
* backup is switched back to in-progress.
*/
PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_stop_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive));
{
/*
* Read the existing label file into memory.
*/
struct stat statbuf;
int r;
if (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &statbuf))
{
/* should not happen per the upper checks */
if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("a backup is not in progress")));
}
lfp = AllocateFile(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, "r");
if (!lfp)
{
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
}
labelfile = palloc(statbuf.st_size + 1);
r = fread(labelfile, statbuf.st_size, 1, lfp);
labelfile[statbuf.st_size] = '\0';
/*
* Close and remove the backup label file
*/
if (r != 1 || ferror(lfp) || FreeFile(lfp))
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
durable_unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, ERROR);
/*
* Remove tablespace_map file if present, it is created only if
* there are tablespaces.
*/
durable_unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP, DEBUG1);
}
PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_stop_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive));
}
/*
* OK to update backup counters, forcePageWrites and session-level lock.
*
* Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them.
* Otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, and which might cause
* do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
*/
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
if (exclusive)
{
XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE;
}
else
{
/*
* The user-visible pg_start/stop_backup() functions that operate on
* exclusive backups can be called at any time, but for non-exclusive
* backups, it is expected that each do_pg_start_backup() call is
* matched by exactly one do_pg_stop_backup() call.
*/
Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups > 0);
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups--;
}
if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE &&
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups == 0)
{
XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = false;
}
/*
* Clean up session-level lock.
*
* You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
* cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
* to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
* CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
* cleaned up before it.
*/
sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
WALInsertLockRelease();
/*
* Read and parse the START WAL LOCATION line (this code is pretty crude,
* but we are not expecting any variability in the file format).
*/
if (sscanf(labelfile, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %24s)%c",
&hi, &lo, startxlogfilename,
&ch) != 4 || ch != '\n')
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
startpoint = ((uint64) hi) << 32 | lo;
remaining = strchr(labelfile, '\n') + 1; /* %n is not portable enough */
/*
* Parse the BACKUP FROM line. If we are taking an online backup from the
* standby, we confirm that the standby has not been promoted during the
* backup.
*/
ptr = strstr(remaining, "BACKUP FROM:");
if (!ptr || sscanf(ptr, "BACKUP FROM: %19s\n", backupfrom) != 1)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
if (strcmp(backupfrom, "standby") == 0 && !backup_started_in_recovery)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
"and should not be used. "
"Try taking another online backup.")));
/*
* During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
* pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
* available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
* end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
* we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
* backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
* however.
*
* We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
* wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
* true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
* the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
* archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
* them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
* available.
*
* We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
* location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
* location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
* pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
*
* XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
* purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
* even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
* an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
* backup history file during recovery.
*/
if (backup_started_in_recovery)
{
XLogRecPtr recptr;
/*
* Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
* full-page writes.
*/
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (startpoint <= recptr)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("WAL generated with full_page_writes=off was replayed "
"during online backup"),
errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
"is corrupt and should not be used. "
"Enable full_page_writes and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
"and then try an online backup again.")));
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
stoptli = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
else
{
/*
* Write the backup-end xlog record
*/
XLogBeginInsert();
XLogRegisterData((char *) (&startpoint), sizeof(startpoint));
stoppoint = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_BACKUP_END);
stoptli = ThisTimeLineID;
/*
* Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
* valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
*/
RequestXLogSwitch(false);
XLByteToPrevSeg(stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLogFileName(stopxlogfilename, stoptli, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
/* Use the log timezone here, not the session timezone */
stamp_time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
pg_strftime(strfbuf, sizeof(strfbuf),
"%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
pg_localtime(&stamp_time, log_timezone));
/*
* Write the backup history file
*/
XLByteToSeg(startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
BackupHistoryFilePath(histfilepath, stoptli, _logSegNo,
startpoint, wal_segment_size);
fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
if (!fp)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
histfilepath)));
fprintf(fp, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %s)\n",
(uint32) (startpoint >> 32), (uint32) startpoint, startxlogfilename);
fprintf(fp, "STOP WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %s)\n",
(uint32) (stoppoint >> 32), (uint32) stoppoint, stopxlogfilename);
/*
* Transfer remaining lines including label and start timeline to
* history file.
*/
fprintf(fp, "%s", remaining);
fprintf(fp, "STOP TIME: %s\n", strfbuf);
fprintf(fp, "STOP TIMELINE: %u\n", stoptli);
if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
histfilepath)));
/*
* Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect,
* this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
* notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
* immediately.
*/
CleanupBackupHistory();
}
/*
* If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
* archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
* needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
* wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
* polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
* of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
* the required WAL.
*
* We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
* history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
* property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
* archived as well.
*
* We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
* assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
* wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
* or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to
* clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
*/
if (waitforarchive &&
((!backup_started_in_recovery && XLogArchivingActive()) ||
(backup_started_in_recovery && XLogArchivingAlways())))
{
XLByteToPrevSeg(stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLogFileName(lastxlogfilename, stoptli, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
XLByteToSeg(startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
BackupHistoryFileName(histfilename, stoptli, _logSegNo,
startpoint, wal_segment_size);
seconds_before_warning = 60;
waits = 0;
while (XLogArchiveIsBusy(lastxlogfilename) ||
XLogArchiveIsBusy(histfilename))
{
CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
{
ereport(NOTICE,
(errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
reported_waiting = true;
}
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_BACKUP_WAIT_WAL_ARCHIVE);
pg_usleep(1000000L);
pgstat_report_wait_end();
if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning)
{
seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */
ereport(WARNING,
(errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
waits),
errhint("Check that your archive_command is executing properly. "
"You can safely cancel this backup, "
"but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
}
}
ereport(NOTICE,
(errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
}
else if (waitforarchive)
ereport(NOTICE,
(errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
/*
* We're done. As a convenience, return the ending WAL location.
*/
if (stoptli_p)
*stoptli_p = stoptli;
return stoppoint;
}
/*
* do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
*
* This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_stop_backup(), by taking the
* system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
* an error handler.
*
* The caller can pass 'arg' as 'true' or 'false' to control whether a warning
* is emitted.
*
* NB: This is only for aborting a non-exclusive backup that doesn't write
* backup_label. A backup started with pg_start_backup() needs to be finished
* with pg_stop_backup().
*
* NB: This gets used as a before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking
* signature.
*/
void
do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
{
bool emit_warning = DatumGetBool(arg);
/*
* Quick exit if session is not keeping around a non-exclusive backup
* already started.
*/
if (sessionBackupState != SESSION_BACKUP_NON_EXCLUSIVE)
return;
WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups > 0);
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups--;
if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE &&
XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups == 0)
{
XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = false;
}
WALInsertLockRelease();
if (emit_warning)
ereport(WARNING,
(errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_stop_backup was called")));
}
/*
* Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
* session, unless this has already been done.
*/
void
register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
{
static bool already_done = false;
if (already_done)
return;
before_shmem_exit(do_pg_abort_backup, DatumGetBool(true));
already_done = true;
}
/*
* Get latest redo apply position.
*
* Exported to allow WALReceiver to read the pointer directly.
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI)
{
XLogRecPtr recptr;
TimeLineID tli;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
recptr = XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr;
tli = XLogCtl->lastReplayedTLI;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
if (replayTLI)
*replayTLI = tli;
return recptr;
}
/*
* Get latest WAL insert pointer
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
{
XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
uint64 current_bytepos;
SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
return XLogBytePosToRecPtr(current_bytepos);
}
/*
* Get latest WAL write pointer
*/
XLogRecPtr
GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return LogwrtResult.Write;
}
/*
* Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
* the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
*/
void
GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
{
LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
*oldrecptr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
*oldtli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
}
/*
* read_backup_label: check to see if a backup_label file is present
*
* If we see a backup_label during recovery, we assume that we are recovering
* from a backup dump file, and we therefore roll forward from the checkpoint
* identified by the label file, NOT what pg_control says. This avoids the
* problem that pg_control might have been archived one or more checkpoints
* later than the start of the dump, and so if we rely on it as the start
* point, we will fail to restore a consistent database state.
*
* Returns true if a backup_label was found (and fills the checkpoint
* location and its REDO location into *checkPointLoc and RedoStartLSN,
* respectively); returns false if not. If this backup_label came from a
* streamed backup, *backupEndRequired is set to true. If this backup_label
* was created during recovery, *backupFromStandby is set to true.
*/
static bool
read_backup_label(XLogRecPtr *checkPointLoc, bool *backupEndRequired,
bool *backupFromStandby)
{
char startxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
TimeLineID tli_from_walseg,
tli_from_file;
FILE *lfp;
char ch;
char backuptype[20];
char backupfrom[20];
char backuplabel[MAXPGPATH];
char backuptime[128];
uint32 hi,
lo;
*backupEndRequired = false;
*backupFromStandby = false;
/*
* See if label file is present
*/
lfp = AllocateFile(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, "r");
if (!lfp)
{
if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
return false; /* it's not there, all is fine */
}
/*
* Read and parse the START WAL LOCATION and CHECKPOINT lines (this code
* is pretty crude, but we are not expecting any variability in the file
* format).
*/
if (fscanf(lfp, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %08X%16s)%c",
&hi, &lo, &tli_from_walseg, startxlogfilename, &ch) != 5 || ch != '\n')
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
RedoStartLSN = ((uint64) hi) << 32 | lo;
if (fscanf(lfp, "CHECKPOINT LOCATION: %X/%X%c",
&hi, &lo, &ch) != 3 || ch != '\n')
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
*checkPointLoc = ((uint64) hi) << 32 | lo;
/*
* BACKUP METHOD and BACKUP FROM lines are new in 9.2. We can't restore
* from an older backup anyway, but since the information on it is not
* strictly required, don't error out if it's missing for some reason.
*/
if (fscanf(lfp, "BACKUP METHOD: %19s\n", backuptype) == 1)
{
if (strcmp(backuptype, "streamed") == 0)
*backupEndRequired = true;
}
if (fscanf(lfp, "BACKUP FROM: %19s\n", backupfrom) == 1)
{
if (strcmp(backupfrom, "standby") == 0)
*backupFromStandby = true;
}
/*
* Parse START TIME and LABEL. Those are not mandatory fields for recovery
* but checking for their presence is useful for debugging and the next
* sanity checks. Cope also with the fact that the result buffers have a
* pre-allocated size, hence if the backup_label file has been generated
* with strings longer than the maximum assumed here an incorrect parsing
* happens. That's fine as only minor consistency checks are done
* afterwards.
*/
if (fscanf(lfp, "START TIME: %127[^\n]\n", backuptime) == 1)
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("backup time %s in file \"%s\"",
backuptime, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
if (fscanf(lfp, "LABEL: %1023[^\n]\n", backuplabel) == 1)
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("backup label %s in file \"%s\"",
backuplabel, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
/*
* START TIMELINE is new as of 11. Its parsing is not mandatory, still use
* it as a sanity check if present.
*/
if (fscanf(lfp, "START TIMELINE: %u\n", &tli_from_file) == 1)
{
if (tli_from_walseg != tli_from_file)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE),
errdetail("Timeline ID parsed is %u, but expected %u.",
tli_from_file, tli_from_walseg)));
ereport(DEBUG1,
(errmsg("backup timeline %u in file \"%s\"",
tli_from_file, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
}
if (ferror(lfp) || FreeFile(lfp))
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE)));
return true;
}
/*
* read_tablespace_map: check to see if a tablespace_map file is present
*
* If we see a tablespace_map file during recovery, we assume that we are
* recovering from a backup dump file, and we therefore need to create symlinks
* as per the information present in tablespace_map file.
*
* Returns true if a tablespace_map file was found (and fills the link
* information for all the tablespace links present in file); returns false
* if not.
*/
static bool
read_tablespace_map(List **tablespaces)
{
tablespaceinfo *ti;
FILE *lfp;
char tbsoid[MAXPGPATH];
char *tbslinkpath;
char str[MAXPGPATH];
int ch,
prev_ch = -1,
i = 0,
n;
/*
* See if tablespace_map file is present
*/
lfp = AllocateFile(TABLESPACE_MAP, "r");
if (!lfp)
{
if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
TABLESPACE_MAP)));
return false; /* it's not there, all is fine */
}
/*
* Read and parse the link name and path lines from tablespace_map file
* (this code is pretty crude, but we are not expecting any variability in
* the file format). While taking backup we embed escape character '\\'
* before newline in tablespace path, so that during reading of
* tablespace_map file, we could distinguish newline in tablespace path
* and end of line. Now while reading tablespace_map file, remove the
* escape character that has been added in tablespace path during backup.
*/
while ((ch = fgetc(lfp)) != EOF)
{
if ((ch == '\n' || ch == '\r') && prev_ch != '\\')
{
str[i] = '\0';
if (sscanf(str, "%s %n", tbsoid, &n) != 1)
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", TABLESPACE_MAP)));
tbslinkpath = str + n;
i = 0;
ti = palloc(sizeof(tablespaceinfo));
ti->oid = pstrdup(tbsoid);
ti->path = pstrdup(tbslinkpath);
*tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
continue;
}
else if ((ch == '\n' || ch == '\r') && prev_ch == '\\')
str[i - 1] = ch;
else
str[i++] = ch;
prev_ch = ch;
}
if (ferror(lfp) || FreeFile(lfp))
ereport(FATAL,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
TABLESPACE_MAP)));
return true;
}
/*
* Error context callback for errors occurring during rm_redo().
*/
static void
rm_redo_error_callback(void *arg)
{
XLogReaderState *record = (XLogReaderState *) arg;
StringInfoData buf;
initStringInfo(&buf);
xlog_outdesc(&buf, record);
/* translator: %s is a WAL record description */
errcontext("WAL redo at %X/%X for %s",
(uint32) (record->ReadRecPtr >> 32),
(uint32) record->ReadRecPtr,
buf.data);
pfree(buf.data);
}
/*
* BackupInProgress: check if online backup mode is active
*
* This is done by checking for existence of the "backup_label" file.
*/
bool
BackupInProgress(void)
{
struct stat stat_buf;
return (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0);
}
/*
* CancelBackup: rename the "backup_label" and "tablespace_map"
* files to cancel backup mode
*
* If the "backup_label" file exists, it will be renamed to "backup_label.old".
* Similarly, if the "tablespace_map" file exists, it will be renamed to
* "tablespace_map.old".
*
* Note that this will render an online backup in progress
* useless. To correctly finish an online backup, pg_stop_backup must be
* called.
*/
void
CancelBackup(void)
{
struct stat stat_buf;
/* if the backup_label file is not there, return */
if (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &stat_buf) < 0)
return;
/* remove leftover file from previously canceled backup if it exists */
unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD);
if (durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, DEBUG1) != 0)
{
ereport(WARNING,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("online backup mode was not canceled"),
errdetail("File \"%s\" could not be renamed to \"%s\": %m.",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD)));
return;
}
/* if the tablespace_map file is not there, return */
if (stat(TABLESPACE_MAP, &stat_buf) < 0)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("online backup mode canceled"),
errdetail("File \"%s\" was renamed to \"%s\".",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD)));
return;
}
/* remove leftover file from previously canceled backup if it exists */
unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
if (durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, DEBUG1) == 0)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("online backup mode canceled"),
errdetail("Files \"%s\" and \"%s\" were renamed to "
"\"%s\" and \"%s\", respectively.",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, TABLESPACE_MAP,
BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD)));
}
else
{
ereport(WARNING,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("online backup mode canceled"),
errdetail("File \"%s\" was renamed to \"%s\", but "
"file \"%s\" could not be renamed to \"%s\": %m.",
BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD,
TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD)));
}
}
/*
* Read the XLOG page containing RecPtr into readBuf (if not read already).
* Returns number of bytes read, if the page is read successfully, or -1
* in case of errors. When errors occur, they are ereport'ed, but only
* if they have not been previously reported.
*
* This is responsible for restoring files from archive as needed, as well
* as for waiting for the requested WAL record to arrive in standby mode.
*
* 'emode' specifies the log level used for reporting "file not found" or
* "end of WAL" situations in archive recovery, or in standby mode when a
* trigger file is found. If set to WARNING or below, XLogPageRead() returns
* false in those situations, on higher log levels the ereport() won't
* return.
*
* In standby mode, if after a successful return of XLogPageRead() the
* caller finds the record it's interested in to be broken, it should
* ereport the error with the level determined by
* emode_for_corrupt_record(), and then set lastSourceFailed
* and call XLogPageRead() again with the same arguments. This lets
* XLogPageRead() to try fetching the record from another source, or to
* sleep and retry.
*/
static int
XLogPageRead(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, XLogRecPtr targetPagePtr, int reqLen,
XLogRecPtr targetRecPtr, char *readBuf)
{
XLogPageReadPrivate *private =
(XLogPageReadPrivate *) xlogreader->private_data;
int emode = private->emode;
uint32 targetPageOff;
XLogSegNo targetSegNo PG_USED_FOR_ASSERTS_ONLY;
int r;
XLByteToSeg(targetPagePtr, targetSegNo, wal_segment_size);
targetPageOff = XLogSegmentOffset(targetPagePtr, wal_segment_size);
/*
* See if we need to switch to a new segment because the requested record
* is not in the currently open one.
*/
if (readFile >= 0 &&
!XLByteInSeg(targetPagePtr, readSegNo, wal_segment_size))
{
/*
* Request a restartpoint if we've replayed too much xlog since the
* last one.
*/
if (bgwriterLaunched)
{
if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(readSegNo))
{
(void) GetRedoRecPtr();
if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(readSegNo))
RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG);
}
}
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
}
XLByteToSeg(targetPagePtr, readSegNo, wal_segment_size);
retry:
/* See if we need to retrieve more data */
if (readFile < 0 ||
(readSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM &&
flushedUpto < targetPagePtr + reqLen))
{
if (!WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(targetPagePtr + reqLen,
private->randAccess,
private->fetching_ckpt,
targetRecPtr))
{
if (readFile >= 0)
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
readLen = 0;
readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
return -1;
}
}
/*
* At this point, we have the right segment open and if we're streaming we
* know the requested record is in it.
*/
Assert(readFile != -1);
/*
* If the current segment is being streamed from the primary, calculate how
* much of the current page we have received already. We know the
* requested record has been received, but this is for the benefit of
* future calls, to allow quick exit at the top of this function.
*/
if (readSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM)
{
if (((targetPagePtr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) != (flushedUpto / XLOG_BLCKSZ))
readLen = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
else
readLen = XLogSegmentOffset(flushedUpto, wal_segment_size) -
targetPageOff;
}
else
readLen = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
/* Read the requested page */
readOff = targetPageOff;
pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_READ);
r = pg_pread(readFile, readBuf, XLOG_BLCKSZ, (off_t) readOff);
if (r != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
{
char fname[MAXFNAMELEN];
int save_errno = errno;
pgstat_report_wait_end();
XLogFileName(fname, curFileTLI, readSegNo, wal_segment_size);
if (r < 0)
{
errno = save_errno;
ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, targetPagePtr + reqLen),
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not read from log segment %s, offset %u: %m",
fname, readOff)));
}
else
ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, targetPagePtr + reqLen),
(errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
errmsg("could not read from log segment %s, offset %u: read %d of %zu",
fname, readOff, r, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ)));
goto next_record_is_invalid;
}
pgstat_report_wait_end();
Assert(targetSegNo == readSegNo);
Assert(targetPageOff == readOff);
Assert(reqLen <= readLen);
xlogreader->seg.ws_tli = curFileTLI;
/*
* Check the page header immediately, so that we can retry immediately if
* it's not valid. This may seem unnecessary, because XLogReadRecord()
* validates the page header anyway, and would propagate the failure up to
* ReadRecord(), which would retry. However, there's a corner case with
* continuation records, if a record is split across two pages such that
* we would need to read the two pages from different sources. For
* example, imagine a scenario where a streaming replica is started up,
* and replay reaches a record that's split across two WAL segments. The
* first page is only available locally, in pg_wal, because it's already
* been recycled on the primary. The second page, however, is not present
* in pg_wal, and we should stream it from the primary. There is a recycled
* WAL segment present in pg_wal, with garbage contents, however. We would
* read the first page from the local WAL segment, but when reading the
* second page, we would read the bogus, recycled, WAL segment. If we
* didn't catch that case here, we would never recover, because
* ReadRecord() would retry reading the whole record from the beginning.
*
* Of course, this only catches errors in the page header, which is what
* happens in the case of a recycled WAL segment. Other kinds of errors or
* corruption still has the same problem. But this at least fixes the
* common case, which can happen as part of normal operation.
*
* Validating the page header is cheap enough that doing it twice
* shouldn't be a big deal from a performance point of view.
*/
if (!XLogReaderValidatePageHeader(xlogreader, targetPagePtr, readBuf))
{
/* reset any error XLogReaderValidatePageHeader() might have set */
xlogreader->errormsg_buf[0] = '\0';
goto next_record_is_invalid;
}
return readLen;
next_record_is_invalid:
lastSourceFailed = true;
if (readFile >= 0)
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
readLen = 0;
readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY;
/* In standby-mode, keep trying */
if (StandbyMode)
goto retry;
else
return -1;
}
/*
* Open the WAL segment containing WAL location 'RecPtr'.
*
* The segment can be fetched via restore_command, or via walreceiver having
* streamed the record, or it can already be present in pg_wal. Checking
* pg_wal is mainly for crash recovery, but it will be polled in standby mode
* too, in case someone copies a new segment directly to pg_wal. That is not
* documented or recommended, though.
*
* If 'fetching_ckpt' is true, we're fetching a checkpoint record, and should
* prepare to read WAL starting from RedoStartLSN after this.
*
* 'RecPtr' might not point to the beginning of the record we're interested
* in, it might also point to the page or segment header. In that case,
* 'tliRecPtr' is the position of the WAL record we're interested in. It is
* used to decide which timeline to stream the requested WAL from.
*
* If the record is not immediately available, the function returns false
* if we're not in standby mode. In standby mode, waits for it to become
* available.
*
* When the requested record becomes available, the function opens the file
* containing it (if not open already), and returns true. When end of standby
* mode is triggered by the user, and there is no more WAL available, returns
* false.
*/
static bool
WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(XLogRecPtr RecPtr, bool randAccess,
bool fetching_ckpt, XLogRecPtr tliRecPtr)
{
static TimestampTz last_fail_time = 0;
TimestampTz now;
bool streaming_reply_sent = false;
/*-------
* Standby mode is implemented by a state machine:
*
* 1. Read from either archive or pg_wal (XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE), or just
* pg_wal (XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL)
* 2. Check trigger file
* 3. Read from primary server via walreceiver (XLOG_FROM_STREAM)
* 4. Rescan timelines
* 5. Sleep wal_retrieve_retry_interval milliseconds, and loop back to 1.
*
* Failure to read from the current source advances the state machine to
* the next state.
*
* 'currentSource' indicates the current state. There are no currentSource
* values for "check trigger", "rescan timelines", and "sleep" states,
* those actions are taken when reading from the previous source fails, as
* part of advancing to the next state.
*
* If standby mode is turned off while reading WAL from stream, we move
* to XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE and reset lastSourceFailed, to force fetching
* the files (which would be required at end of recovery, e.g., timeline
* history file) from archive or pg_wal. We don't need to kill WAL receiver
* here because it's already stopped when standby mode is turned off at
* the end of recovery.
*-------
*/
if (!InArchiveRecovery)
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL;
else if (currentSource == XLOG_FROM_ANY ||
(!StandbyMode && currentSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM))
{
lastSourceFailed = false;
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE;
}
for (;;)
{
XLogSource oldSource = currentSource;
bool startWalReceiver = false;
/*
* First check if we failed to read from the current source, and
* advance the state machine if so. The failure to read might've
* happened outside this function, e.g when a CRC check fails on a
* record, or within this loop.
*/
if (lastSourceFailed)
{
switch (currentSource)
{
case XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE:
case XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL:
/*
* Check to see if the trigger file exists. Note that we
* do this only after failure, so when you create the
* trigger file, we still finish replaying as much as we
* can from archive and pg_wal before failover.
*/
if (StandbyMode && CheckForStandbyTrigger())
{
ShutdownWalRcv();
return false;
}
/*
* Not in standby mode, and we've now tried the archive
* and pg_wal.
*/
if (!StandbyMode)
return false;
/*
* Move to XLOG_FROM_STREAM state, and set to start a
* walreceiver if necessary.
*/
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_STREAM;
startWalReceiver = true;
break;
case XLOG_FROM_STREAM:
/*
* Failure while streaming. Most likely, we got here
* because streaming replication was terminated, or
* promotion was triggered. But we also get here if we
* find an invalid record in the WAL streamed from the primary,
* in which case something is seriously wrong. There's
* little chance that the problem will just go away, but
* PANIC is not good for availability either, especially
* in hot standby mode. So, we treat that the same as
* disconnection, and retry from archive/pg_wal again. The
* WAL in the archive should be identical to what was
* streamed, so it's unlikely that it helps, but one can
* hope...
*/
/*
* We should be able to move to XLOG_FROM_STREAM only in
* standby mode.
*/
Assert(StandbyMode);
/*
* Before we leave XLOG_FROM_STREAM state, make sure that
* walreceiver is not active, so that it won't overwrite
* WAL that we restore from archive.
*/
if (WalRcvStreaming())
ShutdownWalRcv();
/*
* Before we sleep, re-scan for possible new timelines if
* we were requested to recover to the latest timeline.
*/
if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST)
{
if (rescanLatestTimeLine())
{
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE;
break;
}
}
/*
* XLOG_FROM_STREAM is the last state in our state
* machine, so we've exhausted all the options for
* obtaining the requested WAL. We're going to loop back
* and retry from the archive, but if it hasn't been long
* since last attempt, sleep wal_retrieve_retry_interval
* milliseconds to avoid busy-waiting.
*/
now = GetCurrentTimestamp();
if (!TimestampDifferenceExceeds(last_fail_time, now,
wal_retrieve_retry_interval))
{
long secs,
wait_time;
int usecs;
TimestampDifference(last_fail_time, now, &secs, &usecs);
wait_time = wal_retrieve_retry_interval -
(secs * 1000 + usecs / 1000);
(void) WaitLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch,
WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT |
WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH,
wait_time,
WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_RETRIEVE_RETRY_INTERVAL);
ResetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
now = GetCurrentTimestamp();
}
last_fail_time = now;
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE;
break;
default:
elog(ERROR, "unexpected WAL source %d", currentSource);
}
}
else if (currentSource == XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL)
{
/*
* We just successfully read a file in pg_wal. We prefer files in
* the archive over ones in pg_wal, so try the next file again
* from the archive first.
*/
if (InArchiveRecovery)
currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE;
}
if (currentSource != oldSource)
elog(DEBUG2, "switched WAL source from %s to %s after %s",
xlogSourceNames[oldSource], xlogSourceNames[currentSource],
lastSourceFailed ? "failure" : "success");
/*
* We've now handled possible failure. Try to read from the chosen
* source.
*/
lastSourceFailed = false;
switch (currentSource)
{
case XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE:
case XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL:
/*
* WAL receiver must not be running when reading WAL from
* archive or pg_wal.
*/
Assert(!WalRcvStreaming());
/* Close any old file we might have open. */
if (readFile >= 0)
{
close(readFile);
readFile = -1;
}
/* Reset curFileTLI if random fetch. */
if (randAccess)
curFileTLI = 0;
/*
* Try to restore the file from archive, or read an existing
* file from pg_wal.
*/
readFile = XLogFileReadAnyTLI(readSegNo, DEBUG2,
currentSource == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE ? XLOG_FROM_ANY :
currentSource);
if (readFile >= 0)
return true; /* success! */
/*
* Nope, not found in archive or pg_wal.
*/
lastSourceFailed = true;
break;
case XLOG_FROM_STREAM:
{
bool havedata;
/*
* We should be able to move to XLOG_FROM_STREAM only in
* standby mode.
*/
Assert(StandbyMode);
/*
* First, shutdown walreceiver if its restart has been
* requested -- but no point if we're already slated for
* starting it.
*/
if (pendingWalRcvRestart && !startWalReceiver)
{
ShutdownWalRcv();
/*
* Re-scan for possible new timelines if we were
* requested to recover to the latest timeline.
*/
if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal ==
RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST)
rescanLatestTimeLine();
startWalReceiver = true;
}
pendingWalRcvRestart = false;
/*
* Launch walreceiver if needed.
*
* If fetching_ckpt is true, RecPtr points to the initial
* checkpoint location. In that case, we use RedoStartLSN
* as the streaming start position instead of RecPtr, so
* that when we later jump backwards to start redo at
* RedoStartLSN, we will have the logs streamed already.
*/
if (startWalReceiver &&
PrimaryConnInfo && strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") != 0)
{
XLogRecPtr ptr;
TimeLineID tli;
if (fetching_ckpt)
{
ptr = RedoStartLSN;
tli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
}
else
{
ptr = RecPtr;
/*
* Use the record begin position to determine the
* TLI, rather than the position we're reading.
*/
tli = tliOfPointInHistory(tliRecPtr, expectedTLEs);
if (curFileTLI > 0 && tli < curFileTLI)
elog(ERROR, "according to history file, WAL location %X/%X belongs to timeline %u, but previous recovered WAL file came from timeline %u",
(uint32) (tliRecPtr >> 32),
(uint32) tliRecPtr,
tli, curFileTLI);
}
curFileTLI = tli;
RequestXLogStreaming(tli, ptr, PrimaryConnInfo,
PrimarySlotName,
wal_receiver_create_temp_slot);
flushedUpto = 0;
}
/*
* Check if WAL receiver is active or wait to start up.
*/
if (!WalRcvStreaming())
{
lastSourceFailed = true;
break;
}
/*
* Walreceiver is active, so see if new data has arrived.
*
* We only advance XLogReceiptTime when we obtain fresh
* WAL from walreceiver and observe that we had already
* processed everything before the most recent "chunk"
* that it flushed to disk. In steady state where we are
* keeping up with the incoming data, XLogReceiptTime will
* be updated on each cycle. When we are behind,
* XLogReceiptTime will not advance, so the grace time
* allotted to conflicting queries will decrease.
*/
if (RecPtr < flushedUpto)
havedata = true;
else
{
XLogRecPtr latestChunkStart;
flushedUpto = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(&latestChunkStart, &receiveTLI);
if (RecPtr < flushedUpto && receiveTLI == curFileTLI)
{
havedata = true;
if (latestChunkStart <= RecPtr)
{
XLogReceiptTime = GetCurrentTimestamp();
SetCurrentChunkStartTime(XLogReceiptTime);
}
}
else
havedata = false;
}
if (havedata)
{
/*
* Great, streamed far enough. Open the file if it's
* not open already. Also read the timeline history
* file if we haven't initialized timeline history
* yet; it should be streamed over and present in
* pg_wal by now. Use XLOG_FROM_STREAM so that source
* info is set correctly and XLogReceiptTime isn't
* changed.
*/
if (readFile < 0)
{
if (!expectedTLEs)
expectedTLEs = readTimeLineHistory(receiveTLI);
readFile = XLogFileRead(readSegNo, PANIC,
receiveTLI,
XLOG_FROM_STREAM, false);
Assert(readFile >= 0);
}
else
{
/* just make sure source info is correct... */
readSource = XLOG_FROM_STREAM;
XLogReceiptSource = XLOG_FROM_STREAM;
return true;
}
break;
}
/*
* Data not here yet. Check for trigger, then wait for
* walreceiver to wake us up when new WAL arrives.
*/
if (CheckForStandbyTrigger())
{
/*
* Note that we don't "return false" immediately here.
* After being triggered, we still want to replay all
* the WAL that was already streamed. It's in pg_wal
* now, so we just treat this as a failure, and the
* state machine will move on to replay the streamed
* WAL from pg_wal, and then recheck the trigger and
* exit replay.
*/
lastSourceFailed = true;
break;
}
/*
* Since we have replayed everything we have received so
* far and are about to start waiting for more WAL, let's
* tell the upstream server our replay location now so
* that pg_stat_replication doesn't show stale
* information.
*/
if (!streaming_reply_sent)
{
WalRcvForceReply();
streaming_reply_sent = true;
}
/*
* Wait for more WAL to arrive. Time out after 5 seconds
* to react to a trigger file promptly and to check if the
* WAL receiver is still active.
*/
(void) WaitLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch,
WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT |
WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH,
5000L, WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_WAL_STREAM);
ResetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
break;
}
default:
elog(ERROR, "unexpected WAL source %d", currentSource);
}
/*
* This possibly-long loop needs to handle interrupts of startup
* process.
*/
HandleStartupProcInterrupts();
}
return false; /* not reached */
}
/*
* Set flag to signal the walreceiver to restart. (The startup process calls
* this on noticing a relevant configuration change.)
*/
void
StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(void)
{
if (currentSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM && WalRcvRunning())
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("WAL receiver process shutdown requested")));
pendingWalRcvRestart = true;
}
}
/*
* Determine what log level should be used to report a corrupt WAL record
* in the current WAL page, previously read by XLogPageRead().
*
* 'emode' is the error mode that would be used to report a file-not-found
* or legitimate end-of-WAL situation. Generally, we use it as-is, but if
* we're retrying the exact same record that we've tried previously, only
* complain the first time to keep the noise down. However, we only do when
* reading from pg_wal, because we don't expect any invalid records in archive
* or in records streamed from the primary. Files in the archive should be complete,
* and we should never hit the end of WAL because we stop and wait for more WAL
* to arrive before replaying it.
*
* NOTE: This function remembers the RecPtr value it was last called with,
* to suppress repeated messages about the same record. Only call this when
* you are about to ereport(), or you might cause a later message to be
* erroneously suppressed.
*/
static int
emode_for_corrupt_record(int emode, XLogRecPtr RecPtr)
{
static XLogRecPtr lastComplaint = 0;
if (readSource == XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL && emode == LOG)
{
if (RecPtr == lastComplaint)
emode = DEBUG1;
else
lastComplaint = RecPtr;
}
return emode;
}
/*
* Has a standby promotion already been triggered?
*
* Unlike CheckForStandbyTrigger(), this works in any process
* that's connected to shared memory.
*/
bool
PromoteIsTriggered(void)
{
/*
* We check shared state each time only until a standby promotion is
* triggered. We can't trigger a promotion again, so there's no need to
* keep checking after the shared variable has once been seen true.
*/
if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered)
return true;
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LocalPromoteIsTriggered = XLogCtl->SharedPromoteIsTriggered;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
return LocalPromoteIsTriggered;
}
static void
SetPromoteIsTriggered(void)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->SharedPromoteIsTriggered = true;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
LocalPromoteIsTriggered = true;
}
/*
* Check to see whether the user-specified trigger file exists and whether a
* promote request has arrived. If either condition holds, return true.
*/
static bool
CheckForStandbyTrigger(void)
{
struct stat stat_buf;
if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered)
return true;
if (IsPromoteSignaled() && CheckPromoteSignal())
{
ereport(LOG, (errmsg("received promote request")));
RemovePromoteSignalFiles();
ResetPromoteSignaled();
SetPromoteIsTriggered();
return true;
}
if (PromoteTriggerFile == NULL || strcmp(PromoteTriggerFile, "") == 0)
return false;
if (stat(PromoteTriggerFile, &stat_buf) == 0)
{
ereport(LOG,
(errmsg("promote trigger file found: %s", PromoteTriggerFile)));
unlink(PromoteTriggerFile);
SetPromoteIsTriggered();
return true;
}
else if (errno != ENOENT)
ereport(ERROR,
(errcode_for_file_access(),
errmsg("could not stat promote trigger file \"%s\": %m",
PromoteTriggerFile)));
return false;
}
/*
* Remove the files signaling a standby promotion request.
*/
void
RemovePromoteSignalFiles(void)
{
unlink(PROMOTE_SIGNAL_FILE);
}
/*
* Check to see if a promote request has arrived.
*/
bool
CheckPromoteSignal(void)
{
struct stat stat_buf;
if (stat(PROMOTE_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0)
return true;
return false;
}
/*
* Wake up startup process to replay newly arrived WAL, or to notice that
* failover has been requested.
*/
void
WakeupRecovery(void)
{
SetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch);
}
/*
* Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
*/
void
SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
{
SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = sleeping;
SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
}
/*
* Schedule a walreceiver wakeup in the main recovery loop.
*/
void
XLogRequestWalReceiverReply(void)
{
doRequestWalReceiverReply = true;
}